46435 v1 Report No. 46435-PK PAKISTAN’S INVESTMENT CLIMATE LAYING THE FOUNDATION FOR RENEWED GROWTH (In Three Volumes) Volume I: The Main Report December 2009 Poverty Reduction & Economic Management Department Finance and Private Sector Unit South Asia Department Document of the World Bank CURRENCY EQUIVALENTS (Exchange rate effective December 22, 2009) Currency Unit: Pakistan Rupee US$ 1 = Rs 81 GOVERNMENT FISCAL YEAR July 1 - June 30 WEIGHTS AND MEASURES Metric System Vice President: Isabel M. Guerrero Country Director: Yusupha B. Crookes Sector Director: Ernesto May Sector Manager: Simon Bell Lead Economist: Satu Kahkonen Task Manager: Eric D. Manes ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS ADB Asian Development Bank LL Local loop ARPU Average Revenue Per User MoST Ministry of Science and Technology BEEP Business Environment and Enterprise MSTQ Metrology, Standards, Testing, Quality Performance Survey MTDF Medium Term Development Framework BLRC Banking Laws Review Commission NCST National Commission for Science and BoI Board of Investment Technology CCP Competition Commission of Pakistan NEPRA National Electric Power Regulatory CGAP Consultative Group to Assist the Poorest Agency CLRC Corporate Law Review Commission NHA National Highway Authority CPI Consumer Price Index NSS National Savings Scheme CRR Capital Reserve Requirement NTC National Trade Corridor CSF Competitiveness Support Fund NTCIP National Trade Corridor Improvement DISCOs Distribution Companies Program EMBI Emerging Market Bond Index NTDC National Transmission and Dispatch EOBI Employees Old-Age Benefits Institution Company EPB Export Promotion Board NWFP North West Frontier Province ESSI Employee Social Security Insurance OECD Organization for Economic and FBR Federal Bureau of Revenue Community Development FDI Foreign Direct Investment O&P Olley-Pakes FOREX Foreign Exchange PaCCS Pakistan Customs Computerized System FPCCI Federation of Pakistan Chambers of PCST Pakistan Council for Science and Commerce & Industry technology GCR Global Competitiveness Report 2008 PIHS Pakistan Integrated Household Survey GD Goods Document PPP Public private partnerships GDP Gross Domestic Product PRAL Pakistan Revenue Automation Ltd. GOP Government of Pakistan PRSP Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper GST General Sales Tax PSEB Pakistan Software Export Board HEC Higher Education Commission PTA Pakistan Telecommunications Authority HS Harmonized System PTCL Pakistan Telecommunications Company I&I Intelligence & Integrity Limited IASP International Association of Science R&D Research and Development Parks REER Real Effective Exchange Rate IBIS Indus Basin Irrigation System SBP State Bank of Pakistan IC Investment Climate SECP Securities and Exchange Commission of ICI Information communication infrastructure Pakistan ICN International Competition Network SMEs Small and Medium Enterprises ICS Investment Climate Survey SMEDA Small & Medium Enterprise ICTs Information and Communication Development Authority Technologies STEDEC Scientific and Technological IMF International Monetary Fund TEVTA Technical Education and Vocation IMSC Integrity Management Steering Training Authority Committee TFP Total Factor Productivity IP Intellectual Property TIC Technology Incubation Centers IPDF Infrastructure Project Development US United States Facility UNCTAD United Nations Conference on Trade and IPR Intellectual Property Rights Development ISO International Standard Organization UNESCO United Nations Educational, Scientific IT Information technology and Cultural Organization ITES Information technology enabled services USPTO United States Patent and Trademark ITU International Telecommunication Union Office IT&T Information Technology and VAT Value Added Tax Telecommunications WAPDA Water and Power Development Authority KESC Karachi Electricity Supply Company WGI Worldwide Governance Indicators KICT Karachi International Container Terminal WPPF Worker’s Profit Participation Fund LAC Latin American and Caribbean LDI Long distance and international ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS The Pakistan Investment Climate Assessment was requested by the Ministry of Finance of the Government of Pakistan and prepared by a World Bank Team in collaboration with the Small and Medium Development Authority of Pakistan (SMEDA), Pakistan’s Federal Bureau of Statistics (FBS), the Pakistan Board of Investment (BOI). The work was supported by a generous grant from the Department for International Development of the United Kingdom (DFID). The World Bank team was led by Eric Manes and composed of Kiran Afzal, Anjum Ahmad, Mohammad Amin, Alvaro Saez Escribano, Riva Eskinazi, Xiouhui Hou, Ina Hoxha, Isfandyar Khan, Smita Kuriakose, Manuel de Ortiz, Jorge Pena, G.V. Rao, Mehnaz Safavian, Valentian Saltane, Tilahun Temesgen and Namoos Zahir. The team was provided support by Marjorie Espiritu, Sakm Abdul Hye, Imtiaz Sheikh and Rubina Quamber. The manuscript was edited by Nishi Maholta and expertly prepared by Pauline Chin-Mori The SMEDA team was led by Sheharyar Tahir and Sajjad Moghal and consisted of Aisha Amjad, Mariam Anas, Mohammad Raza and Nadia Jahangir Seth. The FBS team was led by Mr Khalid Mamood. The Enterprise Survey was carried out by a team from the firm Sidat- Hyder-Moshen (SHM), a leading management consulting firm in Pakistan. The SHM team was led Samia Zuberi. The work was peer reviewed by Mary Hallward-Dremeier, (DECRG, World Bank) and George Clark, (ECSPF, World Bank) and benefited from comments provided by Faisal Bari, Thomas Buckley, Shahid Javed Burki, Khalid Ikram, Khalid Mirza, Ijaz Nabi, John Nasir, Tatiana Nenova, Erik Nora, Fernanda Nunez, Shahzad Sharjeel, Raghuveer Sharma and Nobuo Yoshida. The report was prepared with the overall advice and guidance from Ernesto May (Director, SASPF), Simon Bell ( Sector Manager, SASPF), Satu Kahkonen (Lead Economist (SASPF) and John Speakman (Lead PSD Specialist, SASPF) from the World Bank and Mr. Shahab Khawaja (Secretary, Ministry of Industries and former CEO), Mr. Shahid Rashid, current CEO and Mr. Jamil Afaqi (General Manager) from SMEDA. The World Bank and SMEDA teams would like to thank the Pakistan Government for the excellent comments submitted on the first draft of the report and for a fruitful discussion on the findings of the study held in Islamabad in February and March 2009. The report not only has benefitted from pre-survey focus group, post survey validation, but as well, written comments from 29 ministries, regulators, provincial governments collected over during 2009 to confirm and validate findings and conclusions while providing additional texture to the ICA’s final messages. ii OVERVIEW OF THE ICA PRODUCT The Investment Climate Assessment (ICA) is a standardized product of the World Bank which systematically analyzes the conditions for private investment and enterprise growth in a country, drawing on the experience of local firms to pinpoint areas where reform is needed to improve the private sector’s productivity and competitiveness. By providing a practical foundation for policy recommendations and involving local partners in the process, the ICA can give greater impetus to reforms which underpin private sector expansion, economic growth and poverty reduction. The ICA bases its findings and recommendations on analysis which has at its center, a representative survey of private enterprises to find out what difficulties they encounter in running a business. The survey intends to capture the firms’ experience in a range of areas—financing, governance, regulation, tax policy, labor relations, conflict resolution, infrastructure services, supplies and marketing, technology and training—all areas where difficulties can add substantially to the pecuniary and non-pecuniary costs of doing business. Using a standard methodology, the assessment attempts to prioritize reform areas according to an three-part analytical framework covering: (i) firm opinions regarding the most important constraints they face, (ii) econometric estimations to attribute firm performance to specific dimensions of the investment climate and (iii) comparison of objective indicators of the investment climate across time, size groups and geographic areas within the country and against indicators in other countries in order to benchmark the country on a global basis. The assessment also provides a baseline so that updates can track progress over time. The findings of the survey, combined with other relevant information from other sources, provide a practical basis for identifying the most important areas for reform aimed at improving the investment climate. The assessments look in detail at policy, regulatory, and institutional factors that hamper the provision of good-quality infrastructure services and the functioning of product, financial, and other markets, linking the constraints to firms’ costs and productivity. In each country the investment climate assessments draw on the guidance and expertise of local partners in government and the business community. The findings and policy recommendations emerging from the assessments have been discussed extensively with the Government, private sector and other stakeholders in the country. Dissemination of the findings is aimed at engaging policymakers, business leaders, investors, nongovernmental organizations, and donors to shape the national private sector development strategy, forge consensus on priorities for reform and lay the groundwork for concrete responses to the identified problems. The survey carried out for the purpose of this assessment is the second done for Pakistan. The first took place in 2001/2002, covering 956 firms in the manufacturing sector. The second took place in 2006/07, covering 1186 manufacturing and 151 service firms. Both surveys took place across Pakistan’s four provinces, but the second was carried out in a way which was statistically representative for urban firms in Pakistan’s 13 principal cities. 401 firms were surveyed both in 2001/2002 and again in 2006/07. The comparator countries were Bangladesh, Brazil, Chile, Egypt, India, Malaysia, Philippines South Africa, Sri Lanka, Thailand, Turkey and Vietnam. iii iv PAKISTAN’S INVESTMENT CLIMATE LAYING THE FOUNDATION FOR RENEWED GROWTH CONTENTS Executive Summary ..................................................................................................................... xi  I. Recent Performance and Structure of Pakistan’s Private Sector ..........................................1  A.  Recent Economic Challenges .....................................................................................1  B.  Structural Issues ..........................................................................................................4  C.  Key Challenges Ahead ................................................................................................6  II. Unleashing Sustained Growth Over the Long Run ...............................................................8  A.  Unleashing Sustained Growth as the Central Pillar for Poverty Reduction ...............8  B.  The Investment Climate’s Role in Supporting Pakistan’s Growth Agenda .............16  C.  Determining Priorities in the Investment Climate ....................................................19  D.  The Way Forward .....................................................................................................30  III. Providing Basic Infrastructure for Commerce ..................................................................32  A.  Introduction. ..............................................................................................................32  B.  Electricity .................................................................................................................33  C.  Transport and Trade Facilitation ...............................................................................39  D.  Water Supply ............................................................................................................43  E.  Telecommunications .................................................................................................46  F.  The Way Forward .....................................................................................................51  IV. Strengthening Governance through Better Regulation .....................................................54  A.  The Business Environment and Competitiveness .....................................................54  B.  Taxation ....................................................................................................................56  C.  Entry, Exit and Anti-Competitive Behavior .............................................................59  D.  Licensing and Permits ..............................................................................................61  E.  Governance and Corruption ......................................................................................64  F.  Crime and Security ...................................................................................................68  G.  The Functioning of Courts ........................................................................................68  H  Public-Private Dialogue ............................................................................................71  I.  Informality ................................................................................................................71  J.  The Way Forward .....................................................................................................73  V. Achieving Flexible Labor Markets and Enhancing Skills...................................................75  A.  Labor Market Overview ............................................................................................75  B.  Education and Skill Levels .......................................................................................78  C.  Labor Regulations .....................................................................................................81  D.  Hiring Practices .........................................................................................................86  E.  The Way Forward .....................................................................................................87  v VI. Expanding Corporate Access to Finance ............................................................................90  A.  Overview of the Financial Sector .............................................................................90  B.  The Importance of Finance to Competitiveness .......................................................90  C.  Financial Market Depth at the Firm Level ................................................................92  D.  Financial Sector Outreach for Manufacturing and Services .....................................94  E.  Cost and Terms of Borrowing...................................................................................97  F.  The Institutional Environment for Lending ..............................................................99  G.  The Way Forward ...................................................................................................105  VII. Absorbing Technology and Fostering Corporate Innovation........................................108  A.  Technology and Global Competitiveness ...............................................................108  B.   Technology Absorption in Pakistan ........................................................................110  C.  Own Resources for Innovation and Technology ....................................................113  D.  Technology Sources from Trade, FDI and Licensing .............................................115  E.  Standards and Quality Certification ..........................................................................119  F.  Science-Industry Collaboration ..............................................................................121  G.  Public Intervention to Encourage Technology-based Entrepreneurship ................122  H.  Technology Commercialization and Bridging Institutions .....................................123  I.  The Way Forward ...................................................................................................125  Annexes Annex A. References ......................................................................................................................... Annex B. Private Sector Background ................................................................................................ Annex C. Investment Climate Variables ........................................................................................... Annex D. Sampling Methodology ..................................................................................................... Annex E. Econometric Methodology for Productivity Estimates ..................................................... Annex F. Econometric Results .......................................................................................................... Boxes Box 3.1: Power Sector Reforms in Pakistan—A Snapshot ...........................................................39  Box 3.2: Simplifying Customs Procedures in Pakistan .................................................................42  Box 7.1: Technology in Textiles ..................................................................................................116  Tables Table 1.1: Trade Balance, FY01-09 .................................................................................................2  Table 1.2: Macroeconomic Indicators, FY05-09 .............................................................................3  Table 1.3: Sector Share of GDP, FY01-09 ......................................................................................4  Table 2.1: Percent of Firms Considering Obstacle as Major / Severe ...........................................20  Table 2.2: Important Investment Climate Variables in 2002 .........................................................21  Table 2.3: Pakistan’s Ranking in the Global Competitiveness Index, 2008-09 ............................22  Table 2.4: Summary of Impact of Individual IC Variables on Productivity and Employment .....25  Table 3.1: Trading Across Borders: Doing Business Indicators...................................................43  Table 3.2: Quality of and Access to Water Supply in Pakistan: ICS Indicators ............................45  vi Figure 4.11: Licenses as Serious Obstacle: Firm Size ...................................................................61  Table 4.1: Dealing with Licenses...................................................................................................63  Table 4.2: Registration of Property Cost .......................................................................................63  Table 4.3: Registering Property Time ............................................................................................64  Table 5.1: Employment Status .......................................................................................................77  Table 5.2: Workers’ Education and Skills .....................................................................................78  Table 5.3: Percentage of Permanent Employees Trained ..............................................................81  Table 5.4: Benefits Coverage .........................................................................................................85  Table 6.1: Bank Lending to Sectors ...............................................................................................95  Table 6.2: Composition of Legal Rights Index for Pakistan .......................................................101  Table 7.1: Innovative Activity by Firm Size ...............................................................................110  Table 7.2: Means of Acquiring New Technology .......................................................................111  Table 7.3: Reasons for Firms not using Either Email or Own Website for Business Correspondence in Pakistan .......................................................................................112  Table 7.4: Joint Ventures in Manufacturing Firms: Comparative Analysis ................................118  Table 7.5: Use of Foreign Licensed Technologies ......................................................................118  Table 7.6: Firms have Obtained an ISO Certification (%) ..........................................................120  Figures Figure 1.1: GDP Growth Rate in South Asia ...................................................................................1  Figure 1.2: Pakistan’s Real GDP .....................................................................................................1  Figure 1.3: Investment and Savings .................................................................................................1  Figure 1.4: Foreign Investment Inflow ............................................................................................1  Figure 1.5: Growth in the Components of GDP ..............................................................................2  Figure 1.6: Manufacturing Growth Rates by Size ...........................................................................2  Figure 1.7: Key macroeconomic Indicators .....................................................................................3  Figure 1.8: Export Growth Rates .....................................................................................................4  Figure 1.9: Economic and Provincial Structure of Pakistan’s Enterprise Sector: 2005 ..................6  Figure 2.1: Decomposition of Differences in GDP per Capita ........................................................8  Figure 2.2: Evolution of GDP Per Capita in Pakistan and Selected Economies with Respect to East Asia, 1990-2006 ....................................................................................................9  Figure 2.3: Labor Productivity Comparisons.................................................................................10  Figure 2.4: Labor Productivity Growth Decomposition in Selected Economies, 2001-2006 .......10  Figure 2.5: Growth Accounting, 1960-2005 ..................................................................................11  Figure 2.6: International Comparison of Allocative Efficiency Term ...........................................13  Figure 2.7: Kernel Estimate of Productivity Density.....................................................................13  Figure 2.8: Changes in the Productivity Distribution ....................................................................13  Figure 2.9: Aggregate and Average TFP Over Time .....................................................................14  Figure 2.10: Kernel Density for Productivity, FY02 and FY07 ....................................................14  Figure 2.11: Aggregate and Average Productivity, 2007 ..............................................................15  Figure 2.12: The Investment Climate’s Transmission Channels ...................................................16  Figure 2.13: Relationship Between Income, Demean Productivity and the Business Environment.................................................................................................................17  Figure 2.14: Share of Productivity and Employment Explained by the Investment Climate ........18  Figure 2.15: Aggregate and Average Demean Log-Productivity Across Countries .....................19  vii Figure 2.16: Percent of Firms Considering Obstacle as Major / Severe ........................................20  Figure 2.17: Most Important IC Constraints ..................................................................................21  Figure 2.18: Top IC Constraints ....................................................................................................23  Figure 2.19: Percentage Contribution of Investment Climate Groups to Productivity and Employment .................................................................................................................24  Figure 2.20: Investment Climate Contributions on Average and Aggregate Productivity ............27  Figure 2.21: Contribution of Investment Climate Variables to Average Productivity by Province and Firm Size ...............................................................................................................28  Figure 2.22: IC Percentage Contributions on Average Employment ............................................29  Figure 2.23: Investment Climate Contribution to Labor Productivity in Services ........................30  Figure 3.1: Contribution of Infrastructure Variables to Productivity and Employment ................32  Figure 3.2: Perceived Quality of Infrastructure .............................................................................33  Figure 3.3: Firms Reporting Electricity as a Major or Serious Obstacle to Growth ...................33  Figure 3.4: Rapid Increase in Domestic Demand ..........................................................................34  Figure 3.5: Demand-Supply Balance: Narrowing Gap ..................................................................34  Figure 3.6: Pakistan’s Energy Mix, 2005 .....................................................................................35  Figure 3.7: Power Sector Prices and Losses Across Countries .....................................................35  Figure 3.8: Waiting Days For Electricity Connection ...................................................................36  Figure 3.9: Informal Payments for Connections ............................................................................37  Figure 3.10: Percent of Firms Experiencing Power Outages .........................................................37  Figure 3.11: Firms’ Losses Due to Power Outages .......................................................................38  Figure 3.12: Own Generation of Electricity ..................................................................................38  Figure 3.13: Firms Owning Transport Equipment and Proportion of Needs Covered Internally .40  Figure 3.14: Transport-related Losses Due to Theft ......................................................................41  Figure 3.15: Trade Facilitation Indicators .....................................................................................43  Figure 3.16: Firms Reporting Water Supply as a Serious Obstacle ..............................................44  Figure 3.17: Firms Reporting Telecommunications as a Serious Obstacle ...................................47  Figure 3.18: FDI in Telecommunications and Mobile/Fixed Density ...........................................47  Figure 3.19: International Comparisons of Total Teledensity .......................................................48  Figure 3.20: Firms Reporting Telecommunications as a Serious Obstacle ...................................48  Figure 3.21: Proportion of Firms Using Either Email or Website. ................................................49  Figure 3.22: Waiting Period for Telephone Connection................................................................49  Figure 3.23: Informal Payment for Telephone Connection ...........................................................50  Figure 4.1: Contribution of Economic Governance Variables to Productivity and Employment .54  Figure 4.2: Business Climate .........................................................................................................55  Figure 4.3: Major Or Very Severe Obstacles To Doing Business .................................................55  Figure 4.4: Global Rankings in Doing Business, 2009/2010.........................................................56  Figure 4.5: Tax Rates as Major or very Severe Obstacle ..............................................................57  Figure 4.6: Effective Total Tax Rate, 2009 ...................................................................................58  Figure 4.7: Percent of Firms Considering Tax Administration as A Major Obstacle ...................58  Figure 4.8: Percent of Firms Using FBR Self-assessment Regime ...............................................59  Figure 4.9: DB Ranking for Starting a Business............................................................................59  Figure 4.10: Cost and Time to Execute Lien on Immovable Property in an Insolvency ...............60  Figure 4.11: Licenses as Serious Obstacle: Firm Size ...................................................................61  Figure 4.12: Obtaining Licenses and Permits as A Serious Obstacle ............................................62  Figure 4.13: Consistent and Predictable Interpretation of Rules ..................................................64  viii Figure 4.14: Interface with Government and Corruption ..............................................................65  Figure 4.15: Relationship Between Inspections and Bribes ..........................................................66  Figure 4.16: Interface with Government and Corruption ..............................................................67  Figure 4.17: Crime and Security ....................................................................................................68  Figure 4.18: Crime Losses & Security Expenses...........................................................................68  Figure 4.19: Courts as a Serious Obstacle .....................................................................................69  Figure 4.20: Use of Courts for Disputes: Internationally ..............................................................69  Figure 4.21: Use of Courts for Disputes: Nationally .....................................................................70  Figure 4.22: Quality of the Courts .................................................................................................70  Figure 4.23: Public-Private Dialogue ............................................................................................71  Figure 4.24: Agency Outreach .......................................................................................................71  Figure 4.25: Percent of Workforce Reported for Tax Purposes ....................................................72  Figure 4.26: Percent of Firms That Say Informality is a Serious Obstacle ...................................72  Figure 5.1: Firm Perceptions of Labor Market Constraints to the Investment Climate ................75  Figure 5.2: Contribution of Labor Market Variables to Productivity and Employment ...............76  Figure 5.3: Labor Force Participation Rates, FY02-06.................................................................76  Figure 5.4: Unemployment Rate, FY01-06 ..................................................................................76  Figure 5.5: International Comparison of Incidence of Hiring Temporary Workers ......................77  Figure 5.6: International Comparison of Average Length of Full-time Seasonal/Temporary Employment .................................................................................................................77  Figure 5.7: Average Education Attainment of Workers in Pakistan .............................................79  Figure 5.8: International Comparison of Perception of Inadequately Educated Workforce .........79  Figure 5.9: Provision of Training to Workers ................................................................................80  Figure 5.10: Labor Market Rigidities ............................................................................................82  Figure 5.11: Perception of Labor Regulation as Obstacle to Current Operations .........................83  Figure 5.12: Labor Inspections ......................................................................................................85  Figure 5.13: Firms Hiring Temporary Workers .............................................................................86  Figure 5.14: Firms Hiring Temporary Workers .............................................................................87  Figure 6.1: Contribution of Finance Variables to Productivity and Employment .........................91  Figure 6.2: Access to Finance as a Major or Severe Obstacle .......................................................91  Figure 6.3: Financial Depth ...........................................................................................................92  Figure 6.4: Sources of Working Capital Finance...........................................................................92  Figure 6.5: Trade Credit as a Source of Working Capital .............................................................93  Figure 6.6: Sources of Investment Finance....................................................................................93  Figure 6.7: Financing Patterns by Manufacturing and Services Sectors .......................................94  Figure 6.8: Outreach by Banks’ Branches and ATMs ...................................................................94  Figure 6.9: Measures of Financial Outreach Across Countries .....................................................95  Figure 6.10: Measures of Financial Outreach Across Countries ...................................................95  Figure 6.11: Access to Finance by Firm-size.................................................................................96  Figure 6.12: Main Reasons for not Applying for Loans or Lines of Credit ..................................96  Figure 6.13: Cost of Borrowing .....................................................................................................97  Figure 6.14: Loan Duration and Size .............................................................................................97  Figure 6.15: Collateral Usage in Lending ......................................................................................98  Figure 6.16: Loan Processing Time ...............................................................................................98  Figure 6.17: Mismatch Between Firm Assets and Collateral Requirements ...............................100  Figure 6.18: Doing Business Legal Rights Index ........................................................................101  ix Figure 6.19: Contract Enforcement..............................................................................................102  Figure 6.20: Public and Private Bureau Credit Information Coverage Across Countries and Over Time ...........................................................................................................................103  Figure 6.21: Time and Cost of Registering Property ...................................................................104  Figure 6.22: Acquisition of New land or Buildings.....................................................................104  Figure 6.23: Land Title Ownership and Property Registration....................................................105  Figure 7.1: Technology Readiness Component of Global Competitiveness Index .....................108  Figure 7.2: The Contribution of Innovation Variables to Productivity and Employment ...........108  Figure 7.3: Share of Firms that Introduced New Technologies in the Last Three Years ............110  Figure 7.4: Total Fixed Broadband Internet Subscribers, 2006 and 2007 ...................................112  Figure 7.5: Electronic Ways to Communicate with Customers and Suppliers ............................112  Figure 7.6: R&D Expenditure as a Percentage of GDP, 2005 .....................................................113  Figure 7.7: R&D Expenditure in Pakistan ...................................................................................114  Figure 7.8: Patents Granted by the USPTO .................................................................................114  Figure 7.9: Researchers in R&D, 2005 ........................................................................................115  Figure 7.10: Pakistan’s Export Orientation .................................................................................117  Figure 7.11: Foreign Direct Investment as Percent of GDP ........................................................118  Figure 7.12: Licensing for Technology Transfer .........................................................................119  Figure 7.13: Share of Firms That Have Obtained ISO Certification ...........................................119  Figure 7.14: Agency Outreach .....................................................................................................123  Figure 7.15: Proportion of Firms Undertaking Innovative Activity Located in Industrial Parks 124  x PAKISTAN’S INVESTMENT CLIMATE LAYING THE FOUNDATION FOR RENEWED GROWTH EXECUTIVE SUMMARY A. Introduction 1. Pakistan has faced a seismic shift in its global and domestic economic landscape which until recently, limited policy options to address investment climate concerns. External shocks, internal policy inaction and political turmoil placed the country in a precarious economic condition, calling on the authorities to take a hard look at the policy choices ahead. Macroeconomic instability resulting in inflation, exchange rate depreciation, and a rapid depletion in foreign reserves became acute in 2007/08, with the adjustment accompanied by a reduction in investment, export and output growth. The recent slowdown in global demand for world trade along with supply shocks from the domestic economy has exacerbated an already monumental challenge for Pakistani firms to prosper and policy makers to respond. 2. As external market conditions and Pakistan’s own stabilization program temper economic expectations, opportunities abound to lay the foundation for expansion. Given Pakistan’s geopolitical positioning, growing labor participation rates, and improvements in the standard of living, significant poverty outcomes can be achieved through sustained economic growth. Even, in the short run, during periods of slower growth, banking system weakness, and corporate distress, Pakistan can take the opportunity to position itself for the inevitable global rebound. Concerted efforts now can improve firm level productivity, fluidity of markets for labor, capital and land, as well as goods, and therefore, better resource use and global competitiveness. 3. During the first part of the decade, outward oriented growth translated into rising savings, increased household incomes and improved poverty indicators but, the expansionary policy stance inflated the economy and left it vulnerable to the external shocks to come. High rates of spending and lower domestic savings increased pressure on internal and external balances, which became unsustainable following the shocks that first came in the form of commodity price spikes and then in a global recession. At the same time, political turmoil made an adequate response to the shocks more difficult. The twin deficits of 7.4 percent of GDP for the fiscal deficit and 8.4 percent for the current account in 2007/08 which followed these commodity price increases were some of the highest in decades. The global and regional events, along with Pakistan’s own stabilization policy requirements to restore balance is causing a major challenge to policy makers across the board for an adequate response to these shocks. 4. Even using pre-shock target growth rates, the needed investment rates exceeded the highest rate ever achieved, emphasizing the immense investment challenge in South Asia. Prior to the global economic downturn, the consensus target growth rate for Pakistan to fully employ its rapidly growing population the vision of a middle income country was around seven percent per annum. This would have implied quadrupling of per capita income in twenty years through accelerated growth in manufacturing in order to raise its share in the economy from 18 to 30 percent, even though manufacturing’s share of GDP rose only 10 percentage point over the xi past half century.1 It would also have required a massive change in the composition of GDP away from consumption and toward investment. Recent growth analyses estimates concur, suggesting that Pakistan would have needed to almost double current investment rates to levels of around 27-29 percent of GDP and achieve high rates of total factor productivity in order to have realized a return to sustainable 7 percent growth levels. B. Restoring Conditions for Growth through an Improved Investment Climate 5. High growth experiences such as those in East Asia, as well as Pakistan’s own history, show that the high rates investment are necessary but not sufficient policy targets. Sustained growth spurts requires an interrelated process of technology adaptation, productivity improvements and economic expansion based on good investment decisions by firms and an appropriate deployment of resources by markets. In Pakistan factor accumulation has been the primary source of growth in over the past five decades, but in periods of growth spurts, high rates of investment were accompanied by rising total factor productivity. Indeed, GDP growth rates comparable with that of India and China during the first half of the decade saw rising investment rates2 but importantly a pro-business, pro-market based policy stance which favored firm level productivity. Though, the expansions are generally short lived in Pakistan, high growth period as also those associated with efficiency gains implying an important role for key investment climate factors such as infrastructure, education, and trade in fostering productivity based growth. 6. The growth paradigm therefore emphasizes higher levels of factor efficiency and improved firm level competitiveness induced through a conducive investment climate. Growth of GDP per capita consists of increased labor productivity and labor force participation. Though Pakistan has experienced high rates of labor force participation, the greatest potential gains in GDP per capita still comes from improved labor productivity. In turn, labor productivity itself relies on both capital accumulation—increased investment per worker—and growth in the efficiency of the use of capital and workers.3 To achieve both requires good macroeconomic policies for stable prices and sustainable balances, favorable external factors, particularly open markets, good commodity prices and reasonable trade policies and importantly, a local business environment supportive of open competition, individual risk taking, and firm expansion. In addition, while three quarters of Pakistan’s income generating investment is generated by the private sector, efficiency of private investment relies on multiplier effects from adequate and reliable provision of public goods—such as infrastructure, health and education, and social safety nets. 7. The analysis suggests that higher growth rates - comparable to those of neighboring countries - are achievable through improvements in key aspects of the investment climate. High rates of population growth in recent years have placed an even higher burden on capital deepening and productivity growth in achieving sustained improvements in income per capita. At the macroeconomic level, the growth accounting decompositions suggest that the productivity 1 Government of Pakistan (2007). Pakistan in the 21st Century: Vision 2030. Planning Commission, Islamabad. 2 The investment to GDP ratio average 17.3 percent during the first five years of the current decade, compared with 18.3 percent during the 1990s as a whole 3 Efficiency in factor use is often referred to as total factor productivity (TFP); a catch all term capturing gains from improved methods, skills, technologies, and other firm level advantages. xii need is related to investment environment improvements.4 At the microeconomic level, enterprise level data collected in 2002 and 2007 and the corresponding firm level analysis confirms other single and cross country analyses which associate potential gains in the firm level productivity with improvements in the investment climate. The analysis extrapolates the strong association between positive and negative dimensions of the investment climate and firm performance by emphasizing the central role of Pakistan’s business environment on the county’s global competitiveness. C. Policy Priorities in the Investment Climate 8. The investment climate assessment sets up an analytical framework to prioritize investment climate constraints for policy considerations and further analysis. Taking advantage of other surveys and market information for cross-checking. The framework triangulates specific investment climate areas to approximate a consistent set of priorities from three directions: (i) firm managers were asked to assess the severity of specific obstacles (absolute ranking) and to indicate which were the most binding (relative ranking) out of a list of possible sixteen. (ii) empirical analysis tested hypotheses associating investment climate variables with firm level performance indicators in order to uncover revealing “statistical� relationships and (iii) investment climate benchmarks compared across thirteen comparator countries, against itself in 2002 and across provinces, sizes and industries. 9. The approach yields consistent indications of priority areas which are examined in greater detailed to provide specific policy recommendations. Since the last survey, improvements can be seen in “first generation� reforms which were areas of attention during the period. In particular, obstacles cited as principal constraints in 2002 are now viewed as secondary. Specifically, firms report lower concern for tax administration, labor regulations as well as customs and trade regulations. At the same time, telecommunications and access to financial services, which were largely privatized during the period, contributed to firm perceptions of an improved business climate during the period. Other potential constraints, including infrastructure (other than power), skilled labor, and business regulation were also not considered by firms to be major constraints to the business environment. However, as described below although firms have not identified these areas as top constraints, key aspects which still remain as constraints to growth. 10. Firms in 2007 prophetically predicted deteriorating conditions in macroeconomic stability, governance and the power sector and the adverse impact of these constraints. In particular, firm ranked power sector issues as overwhelmingly the most serious obstacle facing Pakistan’s investment climate. Whereas less than 40 percent of firms considered the power sector to be a major problem in 2002, this figure more than doubled to 80 percent in 2007. Similarly, more than half of firms surveyed recognized early on that macroeconomic instability was a looming issue in the business environment. Finally, despite improvements in business— governance interface, firms’ perception of corruption and crime worsened. Analysis implies improvement in overall compliance services; business interface declined with managers spending less time dealing with regulation, but the prevalence of corruption is rising in some areas. 4 According to a recent analysis, improvements in public infrastructure, government burden, governance, trade openness and financial depth effected through the structural reforms of the late 1990s, have contributed to about 80 percent of the .70 percentage point increase in the real per capita GDP growth rate observed during 2001-05 compared to the 1991-2000 period. (The World Bank, Pakistan: Growth and Export Competitiveness, 2006, p iii). xiii 11. Empirical analysis of productivity and employment raises the possibility of a deeper duality in the transmission of investment climate impacts to productivity and growth. Although constrained by lack of consistent multi-year data, dynamic analysis using the firms’ productivity distributions in the two periods showed a promising decrease in the concentration firms around low productivity levels. Still in both cases, enterprise surveys suggests that productivity increases associated with investment climate improvements were transmitted through larger market share, formalized firms as compared with more informal, smaller firms that make up the bulk of Pakistan’s enterprise sector. In other words, the positive correlation between market share in the analysis indicates that aggregate productivity gains came through a few firms with a high weight in the sector, (i.e. large market shares) rather than through a productivity across a large number of firms, as observed in countries such as Chile, Mexico and South Africa. 12. The evidence also points to a large number of small firms which are allowed to remain producing at low level equilibriums but may also signal barriers to entry. The observation that high market share firms dominate productivity growth may also signal key issues relating to market entry as explanations for hindrances to growth by smaller firms. While at first glance, the analysis implies productivity transmitting through larger, more established firms as opposed to younger, smaller ones, the analysis also underscores market frictions which allow large market share firms to co-exist with smaller, less formal and lower productivity firms that would normally grow if productive or exit if not. Though the production function approach makes it difficult to untangle competitiveness based on efficiency from market power and profits based on tax, pricing or concessions, certainly growth limiting market frictions exist from poor contract enforcement, limited domestic markets, entry and exit barriers, and regulatory aspects of firm level governance. Global evidence supported here is that improvements in these areas would help the small and medium firms the most. 13. The analysis of the investment climate’s impact on productivity and employment highlights a wide range of ways the investment climate affects economic growth. While infrastructure, economic governance, finance, labor and innovation all play an important role in firm level performance, various aspects of these investment climate dimensions affect different firm groups in different ways depending in part, on the specific nature of the firm. Of particular interest to this study, were the findings that the variables that are positively correlated with productivity (such as access to finance, innovation, and skills training) have, in Pakistan, been transmitted through large market share firms with amplified impact at the aggregate level. Conversely, variables which have a negative association with firm performance, (such as power outages, internal or informal finance and concentrated share holding) are transmitted principally through smaller market share firms and thus are muted in the aggregate. Specific conclusions from the analysis help to define the policy framework which follows:  Variables associated with finance, innovation and labor skills are positively associated with higher productivity but are transmitted through larger market share firms. The enterprise sector, as a whole, does not identify constraints in these areas as high priority, reflecting an equilibrium of low demand for these services by the bulk of smaller firms, but firms which do use these inputs claim deficiency in access.  Variables which reflect more formality (sales reported to taxes, court usage, having a bank account and working capital finance from banks) are positively associated with xiv higher productivity. The positive impact of being formal applies to all firms, regardless of size.  Variables which relate to firms’ ability to cope with business problems (own power generation, security expenses, location in industrial zone, large inventory) are associated with productivity and employment with the positive impact dominated by large firms.  Variables relating to bureaucracy and red tape were no longer significantly associated with productivity and employment in 2007 even though they were identified as negatively associated with both types of firm performance in 2002, supporting firm perceptions and objective indicators, such as management time spent on business regulation has improved.  The analysis underscores concerns regarding deeper areas of governance reform which may encourage informality and underlie constraints on firm level growth. Deficiencies in predictable, transparent and effective systems to protect property rights and enforce contracts, suppress arm’s length business relationships, risk taking, and investment in innovation.  While the impact of various investment climate variables on productivity is relatively robust across provinces and firm size, firms’ perceptions across provinces show notable differences, which have much to do with governance, land availability and power sector issues.  The service sector, in the area of domestic trade is smaller and more informal, is markedly different as compared with manufacturing. As compared with manufacturing, there is more emphasis on economic governance than infrastructure and finance—particularly in those areas which represent business-government interface and manager’s time on regulation. 14. The policy analysis is based on an analytical framework for prioritizing areas of investment climate constraints for devoting various types of attention. In some key areas, such as power, labor, tax, business entry, licensing and financial sector a considerable number of reforms are ongoing and require deepening, but in others, deep seeded and have been entrenched areas of governance reform require attention to unleash constraints to firm level growth. Such governance issues include rising concerns about corruption, the need to better define and protect property rights, speedier and more certain contract enforcement, better regulation of markets, and the elimination of biases in the system against large, formal industrial firms in terms of tax, energy pricing, credit allocation, etc. 15. The analytical framework underscores the priority of having good macro, trade and competition policy in place while focusing attention on critical investment climate areas. As the economy undergoes a strenuous adjustment to past policy conflicts and current market turmoil, the authorities place macroeconomic management and a strong safety net at the top of the policy agenda while maintaining a commitment to an open, competitive trade and foreign investment regime. To sustain these goals over the medium term, a strong investment climate is xv needed and return to a strong growth path, deeper analysis and policy recommendations are made along the following four areas:  Removal of infrastructure constraints particularly in the energy sector: The power sector’s inadequacies have damaged manufacturing growth with supply constraints reaching a critical point. Unlike other areas where differences across size groups, sectors and geographic areas, there is universal agreement regarding the primacy of the power sector issues as an investment climate constraint. In addition, the notable improvements in telecoms and logistics remain undervalued by an aging and inefficient transport system.  Strengthened governance of market mechanisms: Though improving in recent years, antiquated laws, regulatory compliance and red tape at various levels of government are still problematic, burdensome and costly. More importantly are areas related to corruption in business-government interface, property right protection and contract enforcement, speedier and more certain mechanism for corporate exit and elimination of biases in tax, labor, financial and energy pricing which hinder the incentive to grow and formalize.  Increased depth and improved functioning in labor, land and financial markets. Though firms consider access to these factors less of an issue than other constraints such as electricity or governance, the analysis points to a low level equilibrium in these areas. In the case of labor markets, low skills are only a problem for the few firms which have an educated labor force. In finance, large established firms have access to standard relationship banking, but new entrants are shut out. Risk based or capital market products are non-existent.  Attention to firm level technology adaptation and the role of public private partnerships (PPPs) in spearheading progress: The low level of technology used by Pakistan firms has at its core both demand and supply side issues. In addition to infrastructure, PPPs should be investigated, as applied to public goods in cluster development, environmental and social standards, technology upgrading and quality assurance. New, risk based financial products are also required to support entrepreneurship and innovation D. Providing Basic Infrastructure for Commerce 16. High quality and reliable infrastructure is a key component of economic growth and a central pillar of a conducive investment climate. Access to electricity, water, transport and trade facilities are important infrastructure dimensions of competitiveness, requiring attention at all levels of government and the private sector. Business losses due to power failures, inefficient transport services, insufficient water supply, and delays at ports significantly impact costs and risks for firms, create impediments for opportunities and compromise investment interest. The recent Global Competitiveness Report 2009-10 ranks Pakistan at a modest 87 out of 133 in terms of Quality of Infrastructure – after Sri Lanka (63), higher than other South Asian countries including India (89) and Bangladesh (125). It also masks higher rankings in rail (51), roads (65), ports (73) and air (76). More than these needed improvements power is the immediate issue. xvi 17. The power sector in particular, has proved to be a major bottleneck for the economy and a serious threat to overall competitiveness. The GCR ranked Pakistan 124 in terms of the overall quality of electricity supply in 2009-10, far below the overall infrastructure rank of 87 cited above. Inordinate delays in obtaining new power connections significantly impede the ease of entry for new businesses while seriously constraining existing firms in planning business expansions. Even firms with access to electricity face high costs and highly unreliable supply of power with frequent outages, disproportionately affecting firms in different regions. Relative to comparators, firms in Pakistan suffer the most severe financial losses due to power interruptions, with small firms and the textiles sector bearing the highest losses. It is difficult to generalize about prices of electricity relative to other South Asian countries given the amount of technical, collection and efficiency losses in the system. Cross subsidization by industry to households also complicates pricing calculations and imposes a strain on the sector’s sustainability. 18. Growth in electricity consumption in recent years has exceeded earlier projections with this demand pattern expecting to continue with high growth for next few years. Currently planned investments are unlikely to suffice. New investments will be required to enhance generation capacity. Increasing energy efficiency and diversifying the available energy mix will help. The power sector will have to be made financially sustainable to enable better maintenance and future expansion. There is also need to make structural reforms and adjust the regulatory framework to enhance effective corporate governance in the sector. The GOP has also been wrestling with how best to encourage more private sector participation and investment to meet the generation gaps in this sector. 19. Pakistan’s transport sector is operational but inefficient with expensive ports, unreliable rail, poorly maintained roads, stagnant aviation, and under-developed logistics. The relatively high costs, slow turnaround and low reliability of transport constitutes a drag on Pakistan's economic growth, reducing the competitiveness of the country's exports, and constraining the ability of the country to integrate into global supply chains. Policies that reduce transport costs, ensure safety in mobility, and enhance regional connectivity by creating greater synergy between the rural, provincial and federal transport infrastructure will help to increase Pakistan’s competitiveness, raise its share of world trade and foster non-existent regional integration. A better transport and facilitation sector will also bring about structural changes in the industrial and services base through better economic mix, value addition and job creation. 20. Pakistan has devoted considerable resources and effort at improving trade logistics which have borne fruit, both in terms of concrete outcomes and firm perceptions. As a compliment to the significant reduction in tariffs and border taxes that have led to a significant increase in trade volume, the GOP has taken important steps to improve the time and cost for clearing trade shipments, particularly at the Karachi Port, through simplified procedures, paperless, electronic clearance systems and linkages with banks. The result has been a model of reform that has reduced the time between clearance and exit from the port from about 7-1/2 days to 1 day or less. Now, with the exception of firms in NWFP where the issue is more domestic transport to ports and airports, rather than trade logistics per se, managers no longer consider customs and trade to be a significant obstacle. 21. The infrastructure challenge is particularly acute with respect to water. Competition for water is growing among the provinces and across the varied needs for irrigation, industrial and domestic use, and the environment. Due to the nature of its production process, the food sector is the xvii most water-constrained. Quality and reliability of water supply are bigger issues for firms in Pakistan compared to access and the GOP needs a sustainable and long term strategy to address maintenance and development of assets in this sector. As investment is severely constrained in the water sector despite high returns, nontraditional methods for financing infrastructure involving the domestic and foreign private sector, securitization and privatization of existing assets, and PPPs can be explored. 22. The GOP’s reforms in telecommunications have resulted in impressive growth for the sector and made it the least constraining infrastructure obstacle for firms in the country. Both line and mobile penetration have increased nationwide, particularly in rural areas. The increasingly competitive environment has driven down tariff rates that are now among the lowest in the world. However, in contrast to the very high level of voice penetration, internet adoption in the country is very low by international standards. One reason is that the telecommunication policy and ICT policy have been driven separately and thus are headed in different directions – a looming problem as the country prepares for 4G and rural role outs. 23. The private sector’s involvement in provision of infrastructure services is sporadic and far behind the neighboring countries. Pakistan has had significant success in attracting private investments in the telecommunications sector in the 1980s and the power sector in the 1990s aims to deepen that success while broadening to other infrastructure areas such as transport & logistics, water supply, effluent treatment, and irrigation. Progress to date, includes a legal framework for PPP, the establishment of the Infrastructure Projects Development Facility (IPDF) and the recent adoption of a PPP policy. The next steps, on the public side, would be a more specific institutional, set up with clarity on public management at the IPDF and related agencies, of the (i) deal making process, (ii) legal and operational risks and (iii) financial obligations and contingencies. The provincial governments, specifically the Government of Punjab is also working toward developing comprehensive PPP framework, and plans model transactions in power, waste management, toll roads, and others. On the private side, the mobilizing of domestic resources to invest in such new PPP type of vehicles will be create major demands for financial sector deepening and corporate sector transparency. 24. With regard to the way forward, an urgent and aggressive redoubling of reform efforts throughout the infrastructure is required. Higher rates of investment, for example through a fully developed and tested PPP system, as described above are needed to generate additional electricity, relieve power shortages and prevent load-shedding. On the demand side, power efficiency needs to be encouraged through price and non-price means. The sector needs to continue to strive for financial sustainability to enable better maintenance and future expansions while the tariff structure needs to create as much as a level playing field as possible for all users to make the right decisions. In the long run, energy mix diversification should be a key strategic element. 25. In terms of non-power infrastructure, the urgency is lower but no less needed to ensure that Pakistan can compete in a global environment. The National Trade Corridor Investment Project (NTCIP), as the medium-term policy framework for the transport sector, has recorded some early gains but progress is needed to address the transport sector’s main beneficiaries. A small success, such as scaling up the customs pilot, is an urgent, straightforward and achievable goal to get started. In the water sector, the Government needs a sustainable and long-term strategy to address maintenance and development of assets. In telecommunications, xviii the regulatory framework and telecom policy need to keep pace with the fast-changing dynamics of market evolution. E. Strengthening Economic Governance through Better Regulation 26. Business regulation has become less intrusive during the decade, but deep seeded institutional factors remain a hindrance to a more conducive business environment. While the country has done reasonably well by international standards in achieving a less burdensome regulatory environment, it has lagged behind with respect to protection of private property rights, corruption, quality of judiciary, and the law and order situation. These factors affect the economic governance of markets, business relationships and are important determinants of productivity. In the productivity analysis, for instance, statistically relevant governance variables affecting both average and aggregate productivity include “sales reported for taxes�, “gifts to tax inspectors,� “payments to obtain government contracts,� “losses associated with crime and expenses on security,� as well as “the use of courts for conflict settlement.� 27. On the regulatory front, the GOP’s efforts at lowering hurdles for business have had a positive impact on firm productivity and enterprise perceptions of the investment climate. In the 2009 Doing Business rankings, Pakistan ranked 77th in the world in the composite index of ten indicators—best for South Asia, apart from the Maldives. At the same time, firm managers report much less time dealing with regulations as compared to other countries and indeed compared to Pakistani managers only five years ago. Notably, tax administration which was the second ranked obstacle in 2002 when half of firms consider it a major obstacle was in 2007 the eighth most important. Similarly, the various efforts to improve interface with labor inspectors at the provincial level and better customs administration at the ports has also had a positive impact. The challenge now is to deepen the effort on the business regulation front at the federal level and involve more directly provincial and district level government to streamline and unify systems nationwide. 28. On the institutional front, difficult challenges remain as notable improvement requires sustained, long term efforts across a number of fronts. The perception that the quality of courts are an obstacle is expressed by over 36 percent of Pakistani firms compared with approximately 20 percent in comparator countries. This is especially so for sectors such as chemicals which require long-term investments. Firm-perceptions about court speed are reasonably good in Pakistan but lag far behind other countries in impartiality and affordability of courts and especially in the enforcement of court decisions. 29. Crime and security is not as big a problem as corruption in Pakistan but a third of firms perceive it to be a serious obstacle. Expenses on security far exceed losses due to crime in Pakistan, and there is a wide variation among firms—based on size, location and sector of operation—on crime-related expenses and losses. Industrial zones solve many of the infrastructure, agglomeration and indeed law and order type of problems but have failed to provide a corruption-free environment. The number of firms reporting corruption as a major obstacle to business rose from 40 percent in 2002 to 57 percent in 2007 and was even higher for firms which had interface with tax and labor officials, applied for utility connections or licenses or received financial support from the government. 30. Though Pakistani firms do not express serious concern about the competition from the informal sector, informality is nonetheless a challenge to global competitiveness. xix Informality is often defined as avoiding regulations, using informal factor markets – land, labor and finance and/or just being small since business laws cover only firms with more than 10 employees. In Pakistan, the incentives to be informal in some way is enormous, given the difficulty in enforcement and the high burden on formal firms. The result is that firm size remains small, outlook stays local – avoiding arms length transactions with suppliers, banks and customers, and managers lack incentive to augment quality or train labor. As global experience suggests that imposing major constraints creates incentives for businesses to remain informal, good regulatory administration can positively influence the degree of informality in Pakistan. 31. Applying a sound regulatory system and non-distorting product and factor market policies will eventually reduce the incentive for and degree of informality in the system. In the short run, progress in the area of business regulation has had demonstrated effects on the perceptions and efficiency of the business community. However, the performance – for example in business taxation – has not reflected improved administration and collection performance, just less hassle on business. Therefore, more effective administration also requires improved policies – in this case, biases which prevent more neutral application of the tax code across activities. 32. In the end, free entry, good resource allocation and buoyant firm level growth requires strengthened property rights, enforced contracts and speedy dispute resolution. To ease corporate entry, further streamlining of business licensing and property registration areas can be pursued through automation and business process engineering. Reform of some key business regulations requires an effort to encourage provincial authorities to engage in process analysis and re-engineering. The legal framework for companies requires a comprehensive revision, particularly of those aspects dealing with insolvency and liquidation. Finally, a good investment climate requires more than the removal of immediate constraints—it also needs to improve public-private cooperation. With the exception of firms in the textiles and sports goods, few others in Pakistan participate in a public-private dialogue. F. Achieving Flexible Labor Markets and Enhancing Skills 33. A key challenge to the investment climate is how to enhance skills levels and capture the returns to education. A more flexible legislative framework for labor markets is needed to increase autonomy of firm decisions about hiring and firing while providing adequate levels of labor protection and safety. The Pakistani labor market contains a large informal sector while another large share of the workforce, particularly in manufacturing, holds temporary jobs and works on short contracts. In contrast with the large proportion of service sector firms, few manufacturing businesses in the country provide formal training to their employees. This is on top of the fact that more than half of the country’s workers have less than three years of education. 34. Despite what is low levels of education and a rigid labor code, firm managers in Pakistan do not perceive skills, quality of workforce or labor laws to constrain business. This perception does not correlate with actual data and analysis which shows that returns to education increase with progressively higher levels of education. In addition, according to Doing Business indicators on labor market rigidity, Pakistan ranks poorly – worse than Bangladesh, Chile, Philippines, South Africa, Thailand and Turkey. The primary reason for the distinction is weak enforcement, as firms are able to find ways to circumvent strict regulations, such as hiring temporary workers or participating in informal labor markets (e.g., hiring through third parties). xx 35. Strict labor legislation combined with weak enforcement has many adverse implications for the fluidity of labor market and the incentives to invest in training. These practices may hamper employment growth in the long run as they increase labor market inefficiency and limit the mobility of workers. For example, when term contracts are limited in scope and duration and constrained autonomy is granted to firms with regard to hiring and firing decisions, the working of the formal labor market is severely restricted, as it is in Pakistan. In addition, the adjudication mechanism for firing or retrenching involving provincial Labor Tribunals is complex, making outcomes uncertain. Finally, despite mandated benefit packages for workers the high taxes are avoided by hiring labor through informal channels. Since the benefits do not effectively accrue to workers they are not demanded. Therefore due to legislated restrictions on hiring, judicial challenges to firing, and expensive mandated benefits, many firms in Pakistan hire temporary workers to increase autonomy and flexibility while reducing costs. 36. In terms of the way forward, these study’s findings point to a need for strengthened education and improved legislative underpinnings for labor market fluidity. Strengthening the public and private provision of the educational system is a fundamental necessity for promoting innovation and improving productivity. Providing incentives to increase firm training and foster transferable skills among workers is important to promote innovations and enhance firm productivity and requires a major labor code reform which is now underway. The first major steps have been taken in terms of the legislative process, with a pipeline of major activities about to be launched. In addition, the enforcement of these combined federal laws will require reforms of the inspection regime which ensures minimized red-tape, bureaucratic hassles and extra costs on businesses. Developing a labor inspection policy framework to reorganize and streamline labor inspection services, and eliminating corruption during inspection, should go a long way towards encouraging more employment in the country’s formal sector. G. Expanding Corporate Access to Finance 37. The financial sector in Pakistan is dominated by banking activity which was bolstered by deep and fundamental reforms in banking initiated over the past decade. In addition to the banking sector being one of the fastest growing and most profitable in the region, it remains relatively sound and appears to have been surprisingly resilient in the face of macroeconomic challenges faced by the economy the past two years. Stress testing in the summer of 2008, showed pockets of weakness, but generally revealed resiliency in the financial structures. In examining the impact of terms and conditions associated with credit products on credit usage, it is seen that lending rates have been low in real terms as are processing fees. However, the terms of loans are much shorter and loan sizes larger in comparison with other countries. Bank requirements for collaterals against loans are higher compared to global competitors. 38. In addition to its safety and soundness concerns, efforts to encourage more diversity in bank lending has been a policy goal of the State Bank for some time. Corporate lending has remained the primary business at almost two thirds of the banks’ lending portfolio but access to financial services and products by non-corporate clients remains low compared to countries with similar income levels. Beginning with efforts to expand into consumer lending in the early part of the decade and to encourage to SME lending in the form of specialized prudential and regulatory norms, SBPs efforts have had a positive result in terms of the stated goals. Such efforts have helped in this respect but, as a percentage of total lending, the share of SME finance xxi has decreased from 2004 through 2007 as firms have remained focused on large groups and consumer lending. The State Bank is also look for increased activity in longer term activities by bans, such as in the area of housing and infrastructure finance. 39. Financial sector reforms have had a significant positive impact at the firm level but have a long way to go to increase the financial deepening needed to support growth. The domestic firms’ perception that access to finance as a major obstacle to the investment climate has reduced considerably between 2002 and 2007 and what was the 5th ranked obstacle is now 9th ranked. At the same time, the productivity analysis shows that access to bank financing is associated with higher productivity with the line of causation likely going in both directions. However, non- “blue chip� companies still find it challenging to secure finance and rely instead, on retained earnings to finance working capital and investment needs. As a result, trade credit plays a smaller role in working capital financing as compared to other countries. The predominant reason cited by firms of all sizes is not lack of access of own decisions to opt out of the formal credit market for a number of reasons. As a result the financial outreach to businesses in Pakistan is limited, with small and medium firms showing significantly lower rates of credit usage as compared to large firms. 40. Gaps and deficiencies in the institutional framework limit the propensity to lend and borrow. Such gaps include the enforceability of legal and contractual rights of lenders and borrowers, prudential regulations and supervision which encourages banks to diversity their lending while maintaining sound and prudent lending practices and more extensive use of credit information. Therefore; burdensome requirements for risk management, lack of transparency for credit decisions and prudential regulations that allow banks to focus on large, known groups, may be among the factors driving low credit use by firms other than the known big players. Improvements in these institutional areas will enable greater outreach, more tailored products and better terms of lending. 41. In terms of the way forward, a range of reforms is needed to increase the depth and outreach of finance. Prudential regulations allowing high concentration on single party and single group exposure should be made consistent with international norms. Reconciliation and strengthening of the supervisory role of the State Bank of Pakistan (SBP) and the Securities and Exchange Commission of Pakistan (SECP), including jurisdictional clarity in some cases is needed to ensure the sector’s safety and soundness and encourage financial deepening. Strengthening the enforcement of contracts is paramount to increasing financial access by fostering arms-length transactions between firms and between lenders and firms. In particular, reforming collateral systems and establishing a national internet-based filing archive of security interests in movable collaterals would allow firms of all sizes to better exploit their productive assets to secure credit. In addition to moveable collateral, better enforcement of ownership rights when it comes to land titling is an urgent but difficult area. While greater access and outreach to individuals could have a multiplier effect on enterprise finance, outreach would also be fostered by improving and deepening credit information systems in order to lower perceived risk. H. Absorbing Technology and Fostering Corporate Innovation 42. In the present global environment, higher rates of technological absorption, better organizational methods and faster innovation are essential for firms to compete. The current competitive environment for products in Pakistan’s specialization, consists of access to global value xxii chains, shortened product life cycles, and for more differentiation in product design and development. Yet in spite of significant deregulation and privatization initiated in the 1980s, the Pakistan economy remains burdened by many inefficiently run enterprises and an industrial structure dominated by low technology products. Despite ample opportunities to develop local information technology (IT) and IT enabled services (ITES) industries, the indications are that most Pakistani firms have not yet embraced IT for use in their own daily business activities. 43. Innovation can be obtained through absorption of own produced technological advance and by acquiring already produced technology and adapting it to local conditions. In terms of own produced technology, research and development (R&D) activity in Pakistan is dominated by the Government without the complementary private sector R&D investments needed to foster commercially viable innovations. The number of firms applying for patents, innovating via the introduction of new products, or upgrading existing product lines is very low in Pakistan. The U.S., amongst others, has demonstrated how technology often geared for military uses, has found its way to commercial applications, but there was a heavy need for private R&D in the process of conversion. Pakistan has also been unable to attract off shoring R&D activities by multinational firms, primarily due to a poor investment climate for protection of investor rights and a lack of relevant educational attainments in its workforce. 44. On the other hand, of greater concern is the fact that Pakistan is does not seem to access existing, readily available technology through trade, foreign direct investment and licensing. High-technology represents an increasing but very low share of Pakistan’s total manufacturing exports and imports. Low technology goods, mostly textiles, make the bulk (more than 75 percent) of the exports while nearly all segments of the textile sector, from cotton cultivation to manufacturing of garments, lack modern technology—compared to competitors such as Turkey, Indonesia and Korea which have used the latest technologies to help capture and sustain global export market shares. At the same time, net FDI inflows as a percentage of GDP in Pakistan have been increasing steadily but are lower than those in other comparator countries with recent events in the country causing the bottom to fall out of foreign investment market. 45. Traditional forms of technology transfer are not being used to the extent possible and could be more aggressively pursue by all parties. Alliances and joint ventures could be used more to transfer technology as is licensing as a traditional technology transfer mechanism for firms in developing countries. As Pakistani firms are far behind in obtaining quality certification of the type attractive to international partners, one approach would be for the Government to encourage the adoption of industrial standards to promote quality upgrading, enhancing competition, and diffuse technology. 46. Governments at all levels can play a vital role in creating incentives for firms to invest in riskier technologies as well as crowding in investments that serve a public role. As Pakistan pursues technology transfer and absorption, it is critical for policy makers to keep in mind the importance of the sequence of efforts. Such a sequencing approach should be integral to the overarching science and technology policy in order to provide clear strategic focus for strengthening the incentive regime to better foster innovations and encourage firms to internalize productivity gains from local and global innovation spillovers. This will require first, a conducive investment climate based on appropriate returns to risk, availability of corporate and risk based finance, such as venture capital, a competitive environment and the provision of quality infrastructure, including power, transportation and communications. Second, an enabling xxiii environment for risk taking may require focus on creating stronger regulatory and enforcement framework for electronic data protection, intellectual property rights (IPR), and cyber crime as well as a sound judicial system to enforce them. Finally, necessary public goods should be developed such as skills development, quality certification by a recognized accreditation agency and standard upgrading to promote exports. 47. More directed actions may also be appropriate to strengthen Pakistan’s stance as a knowledge-based economy. For example, as noted above, the adopting new technologies will require investment in new skill development, which due to the lead time involved and the spillover impact, may be subsidized by the public sector, facilitated through directed programs at Diaspora and supported by investment in polytechnic institutions. Narrowing the technology gap also requires that considerable resources be directed towards specific infrastructure development in order to raise the currently low penetration of the broadband network. Bridging institutions like incubators, science and technology parks and technology transfer centers can be focal points for PPPs to directly facilitate local innovation. Finally as the development of knowledge transfer linkages between industry and academia remains a major challenge for Pakistan, technology adoption schemes financed through matching grants can be powerful ways of kick-starting innovation. I. The Reform Program 48. The policy recommendations envision a short and medium term reforms to renew growth rates of the levels needed to reach the Pakistan’s vision of middle income status. The recommended program is predicated upon maintenance of macroeconomic stability and a gradual easing of the global recession while seeking a growth path based higher firm level productivity, well functioning markets, free and fair competition and continuation of the structural transformation needed to enhance global competitiveness. 49. The program represents wide reaching reforms in infrastructure, economic governance, innovation policy and market regulation for land, labor and finance While the program reflects the observation that Pakistan’s economy has shown strong positive supply responsiveness to first generation investment climate reforms in the past, it also recognizes the steep challenges faced by current policy makers. In this way, the program considers as a priority, the significant effort required to improve fundamental economic governance in the area of business-government interface, enforcement of property rights in land and immovable collateral, more certain contract enforcement by the judiciary, and strengthened institutions of regulation. xxiv MATRIX OF POLICY RECOMMENDATIONS Deficiency in the Recommended and/or Planned Recommended and/or Planned Investment Climate Actions for the Near Term Actions for the Medium Term Macroeconomic and Growth framework Foundation For Trade Inadequate revenue performance and Reduce fuel, power and other Tax policy reform to widen net, Led, Knowledge high rates of subsidies causing industrial subsidies eliminate exemptions and improve Based, Policy unsustainably high fiscal deficits collection. Framework Squeeze and prioritize development Biases toward domestic consumption spending to bring down deficit Coordination of new public investment leads to boom-bust growth spurts program based on good appraisal and Improve tax collection and feasibility analysis Accommodating monetary policy administration leading to high inflation and too much Implement and commit to interest rate central bank financing Eliminate accommodating monetary determination from indirect instruments policies (central bank financing), of monetary policy Interest rates, exchange rates and some prices have administered elements in Maintenance of real, positive interest their determination rates and flexible exchange rates Lagging productivity limits trade competitiveness and economic growth. Security and political concerns makes attracting foreign investment and exporting more difficult Implementation of Record of implementation lags and Consolidate competitiveness strategy Establish institutional set up for Broad-based lapses when it comes to investment based on analytical work and donor monitoring and evaluating Investment Climate climate reforms. funded programs for disseminating implementation of investment climate Reforms and discussing reforms. Multiple initiatives but lack in the consolidation of a strategic action plan Prepare short term and longer term Implement action plan for short and for guiding policy makers action plan based recommendations longer term investment climate reforms identified below with time frame and described below. No monitoring function to report on accountabilities implementation by high ranking committees. Conduct investment climate conference involving the provincial governments to incorporate provinces into discussion on implementation arrangements Infrastructure Power Frequent power outages and load Rationalize pricing through tariff Seek out and implement PPP shedding causing work stoppage and notification that distributes costs more partnerships for massive investment in inefficiencies in business equitably, increases supply of additional generation capacity electricity and reduces losses. High level of losses throughout system Invest in Hydropower through threatens maintenance, expansion and Strengthen NEPRA’s legal and construction of four identified dams. sustainability of unbundling strategy. political ability to ensure more timely price changes between determination Increase energy efficiency though use Inadequate pricing causes businesses to and public notification of tariffs. of metering and energy saving subsidize system losses and consumers equipment from pricing based on preventing improvements. Clear circular debt for payment to demand. Mount awareness campaigns. IPPs Resulting low per capita usage of Achieve financially sustainability of energy limiting degree of Ensure that current PPP framework is WAPDA and distribution companies to industrialization, role of innovation and conducive to power generation and enable better maintenance, future possibility of conservation gains test through PPP pilot. expansions and private participation. Install new plants and fast track public Diversify energy mix to shift balance investment through GENCOs. from oil to clean coal as well as nuclear, wind, solar and other renewable sources xxv MATRIX OF POLICY RECOMMENDATIONS Deficiency in the Recommended and/or Planned Recommended and/or Planned Investment Climate Actions for the Near Term Actions for the Medium Term Transport & Logistics In ports, improvements in customs Karachi Port Trust to review tariff Legal framework revised to corporatize clearance and handing times have been structure and free storage policies to ports, port operations privatized or offset by long dwelling times and port become more commercial and reduce outsourced and staff of KPT congestion. congestion rationalized as landlord port. In trade facilitation, the considerable Based on the PaCCs pilot experience, Implement automated nation-wide progress in customs clearance is roll out pilots to other customs points single window electronic system to contrasted with the lack of storage and to cover increasing share of imports. integrate all stakeholders into unified freight forwarding sector. system. Open Government cargo to lines other In transport, costs are low, but are offset than Pakistan National Shipping Carry out review of financial and by inefficiencies in shipping, railways, Company (PNSC) insurance industry issues which prevent trucking and civil aviation freight forwarding. Open track access to private operators, Bias in operations for passenger traffic particular in Karachi-Lahore corridor. Review and rationalize fiscal incentive at the cost of freight services, rolling system for private shipping companies. stock and maintenance. Develop joint service between public railway and private freight forwarders Transform Pakistan Railways into a for Karachi-Lahore corridor corporate entity with autonomous management, streamlined operations Formalize trucking industry and and focused on core activities. increase competition. Allow imports of used trucks and remove preference Rationalize and separate passenger for local parts suppliers. from freight lines to eliminate cross subsidy by freight. Formulate civil aviation policy which promotes fair competition and Improve National Logistics Cell and safeguards for the public interest. strengthen governance of Road Maintenance Account under NHA Prepare annual business plan for road sector, introduce better management of Open civil aviation to competition and corridors achieve international standards of safety and security regulation Rationalize, restructure and consider privatization of PIA. Water and Sewage Long waiting periods and low reliability Upgrade small and medium water Expand and improve the infrastructure in terms of supply interruptions. reservoirs ongoing dam/canal projects for water through investment in dams, and rehabilitate irrigation systems in storage reservoirs and canals. Sindh and Punjab Invest in collecting and treating urban Install pilot plants for solid waste and industrial waste consumptions Establish and empower the Pakistan Water Council to oversee the implementation of integrated water management policy. Telecommunications Low broadband penetration limits Unify approach to ICT and Improve spectrum management system innovations and globalization telecommunications policy so that for effective competition among new data, voice and other services are technologies. bundled together Strengthen capacity of regulator Update regulatory framework and technical skills of regulator to maintain Implement ICT action plan for new modernized sector. unified IT and telecommunication Prepare ICT action program for unified IT and Telecommunication policy xxvi MATRIX OF POLICY RECOMMENDATIONS Deficiency in the Recommended and/or Planned Recommended and/or Planned Investment Climate Actions for the Near Term Actions for the Medium Term Economic Governance Taxation Poor collection and inadequate Begin organizational reform of FBR Review anti-export biases arising from coverage of tax system leading to Target non-compliant tax payers taxation, through tax audits (i) high rate of non-compliance, rent- Introduce VAT to replace GST seeking and corruption Continue process of reducing tape monitoring tax-tax payer interface Rationalize tax regime to expand base (ii) undue burden of taxation on to untaxed areas, and eliminate formalized industrial firms and exemptions. (iii) fiscal pressures at the federal and Implement integrated tax administration provincial levels organization on a functional basis for FBR. Business Licensing Varied processes among districts for Carry out national and sub-national Carry out federally sponsored process business regulation such as licensing level process review on licensing reengineering competitions at property registration, provincial and district level. Establish regulatory reform working groups at provincial level to share and Formulate cost-benefit review of exchange approaches common and non common processes Company Registration Registration process is paper based, and Promote recent roll-out of electronic Undergo process reengineering based involves many steps, agencies and platform for firm registration and on one stop electronic and physical excessive time, including the need for corporate reporting. platform to combine steps for benefit of applicants to travel to main city. the company. Connect with other agencies (e.g. EOBI, WWF, SSN, FBR), to investigate combined registration. Corporate Insolvency Solvency process incorporated in 1984 Introduce unified insolvency law Establish insolvency benches in the High and Modernized Companies Ordinance which promotes which incorporates reorganization, Courts and if applicable, federal court and Companies Law obsolete antiquated liquidation process creditor rights, and is open to be train court officials harmonized for future secured Separate legislation and attention to transaction legislation. Establish profession and accrediting of rehabilitating companies and for receivers. banking entities threatens fragments insolvency regime Introduce new Companies Act to govern all corporations Courts and Property Property right, contract and labor Roll Out Alternative Dispute Strengthen and train commercial Rights disputes are lengthy, uncertain and not Resolution Pilots benches conducive to business requirements Form commission to investigate Review options for for federal options for reforms in the judiciary commercial court, including specialty federal business court judges and streamlines processes. Labor Markets and Skills Labor Regulation Strict labor regulation and weak Introduce new Form cross-Provincial Labor working Reform enforcement induce inefficiency in (i) Labor Policy (2010) group to implement Labor Inspection labor market and Protection policies for enforcement (ii) Employment and Services of ESCA and OSHA Conditions (ESCA) Implement labor inspection registries, (iii) Occupational Health and Safety third party audits, ombudsman or other Act (OSHA) forms of checks and balances (iv) Model regulations for the above based on provincial participation Carry out review of Labor Tribunal in formation and implementation. system to gauge effectiveness and propose reforms xxvii MATRIX OF POLICY RECOMMENDATIONS Deficiency in the Recommended and/or Planned Recommended and/or Planned Investment Climate Actions for the Near Term Actions for the Medium Term Labor Welfare Firms are significant facing taxation Carry out review of labor welfare and Introduce new Labor Welfare and which makes wages less competitive taxation system Social Security Act based on review without concomitant benefits to workers. Review effectiveness of programs supported by labor taxes and consider options for pension system Labor Skills through The demand and supply of educated Support vocational training schools at Provide incentives to increase trainings Vocational Training and technical workers settles at a low the provincial level with public-private provided by firms, equilibrium partnerships, Establish matching grant fund to Design program for accrediting businesses and/or associations for skills vocational training bodies with based programs international partners Implement t reward based/challenge based system to encourage accreditation of vocational bodies. Firms Access to Finance Prudential Regulations The single party credit limits are too Implement stepwise program to lower Carry out prudential standard review in high and prevent banks from seeking the single party and single group limit light of financial crises, access to out lending opportunities. to international standards finance and competition concerns. Prudential Supervision Need for better jurisdictional lines to Reform of financial sector laws (SBP, Strengthened regulation and supervision promote non-bank institutions and SECP, BCC, etc) to clarify of a privatized insurance and pension better supervision of conglomerates jurisdictional lines, strengthen industry. independence and quality of the body, Financial regulators need stronger strengthen intervention. independence and power to intervene. Strengthened property Land titling and registration system Empower one provincial agency to Establish computerized registry of all rights in Immovable prevents clear property rights and limits register real property and provide land titles for each province. Property mortgage possibility. ownership for new registrations. Eliminate opaque transfer practices Strengthened Property Deficiencies in movable collateral Introduce stand alone secured Provide training of bankers, businesses Rights in Movable system limits range of assets to be transaction law and establish filing and judicial officials in secured Property. capitalized and suppressing investment system for registering security interest. transactions systems. Credit Information Low participation, fragmented Assess feasibility of integrating public Introduce program of consumer System information coverage and limited use and private systems and expand protection along with legal and information coverage and participants. regulatory strengthening if necessary. Outreach and Limited private sector skills for SME Provide grants for private lenders and Rationalization and/ privatization of downsizing services. downsizing, leasing and trade finance leasers to adopt down sizing packages state owned financial institutions Innovation and Technology Policy Framework Fragmented and antiquated policy Develop innovation strategy based on Directed policies toward knowledge framework. competition, infrastructure and an based activities to identify public goods open trade and investment regime. and warranted public subsidies Develop ICT/Telecommunications in Rationalize investment incentives for tandem to prepare for next generation IT investments under the ICT policy Infrastructure Inadequate infrastructure, including Do feasibility study of IT hubs in Longer term power sector reform power supply and fiber network major cities of Pakistan to help described to provide uninterrupted and encourage infrastructure investments. affordable power supply. xxviii MATRIX OF POLICY RECOMMENDATIONS Deficiency in the Recommended and/or Planned Recommended and/or Planned Investment Climate Actions for the Near Term Actions for the Medium Term Low Skill Base Low skill base, particularly in science Expand various Diaspora programs to Invest in provision of science and and technical fields attract scientific community abroad. engineering education . Too few graduates are with basic Incorporate corporate input to syllabi to business skills necessary to support increase practical course content. knowledge based activities in industry. Subsidize short-term training to for productivity and skills enhancement Science- Industry Research institutes and industry in Introduce more flexible legal and Encourage career and financial returns Collaboration Pakistan have little cooperation abroad administrative arrangements based on patent activity and research commercialization Government established technology Encourage mobility between research parks and IT Parks has been and industry Support incubators, science / unsuccessful in commercialization technology parks and facilitators of Recognize patenting activity as “process� for technology transfer. Efforts to strengthen effective important criterion for career partnerships with the private sector in progression Package “soft� services such as technology have not yet taken hold. advisory, mentoring, training, business consultancy quality systems. Quality Standards Quality systems and local patent Strengthen enforcement of electronic Investment is ISO certification through System constrained y perceived lack of data protection, intellectual property upgraded testing facilities provided on a responsiveness, technical knowledge, rights and industrial cyber crimes nationwide basis. and legal protection (enforcement). Strengthen quality certification Improve and restructure the patent accreditation agencies and establish office in Pakistan in order to have faster international partnerships and higher quality service Finance for Innovation Limited or no risk based capital in Deepened financial sector with private Feasibility study for government Pakistan and no program for matching sector venture based on sustained financed, privately run venture fund grant start ups. reform program and transparent providing equity, loans and grants corporate sector. NBFI development to intermediate sources of risk capital which may exist in the system, once stabilized. xxix PAKISTAN’S INVESTMENT CLIMATE: LAYING THE FOUNDATION FOR RENEWED GROWTH I. RECENT PERFORMANCE AND STRUCTURE OF PAKISTAN’S PRIVATE SECTOR A. Recent Economic Challenges 1. For the first part of this decade, Pakistan enjoyed relative economic stability and strong growth, but the policies followed left the economy vulnerable to external shocks. Pakistan has in the past demonstrated episodes of strong growth, such as in the 1960s and 1980s when average annual growth averaged 6.8 and 6.5 percent respectively. During 2002-2007, Pakistan’s economy was one of the fastest growing in Asia, annual real GDP growth averaging almost 7 percent (Figures 1.1 and 1.2) and reached levels of India and China in FY05. The country’s growth spurt was translating into rising per capita income which reached US$878 in FY07―an 18.3 percent increase from FY05. However, the growth, as has been Pakistan’s history with growth episodes, was short lived and ended in a financial stresses teetering on a balance of payments crises. With the highest volatility of growth in the region, Pakistan, seeks a more sustained and predicable path toward poverty reduction, beginning with renewed growth. Figure 1.1: GDP Growth Rate in South Asia Figure 1.2: Pakistan’s Real GDP 10 10 9 8 8 GDP growth rates 7 6 6 GDP 5 4 Pakistan 4 India 3 2 Bangladesh 2 China 1 0 0 FY02 FY03 FY04 FY05 FY06 FY07 FY08 FY09 FY02 FY03 FY04 FY05 FY06 FY07 FY08 FY09 Source: Pakistan Economic Survey 2008-09, consensus projection. 2. The growth was supported by a pro-business policy stance and facilitated by political and macroeconomic stability, benign external conditions, and available external financing. The package of first generation policy reforms included: (i) privatization of public enterprises; (ii) opening of markets to trade and investment; (iii) strengthening of regulatory institutions in telecom, power, oil, gas, tax, financial markets, and competition; (iv) and (iv) a reduction of bureaucracy and red tape in business-government interface. As a result, private investment rose from 11.3 to 16.4 percent of GDP during FY03-07 and foreign direct investment (FDI) more than quintupled over the period from less than US$1 billion in FY03 (Figures 1.3 and 1.4) as did donor inflows and overseas remittances during the same period. Figure 1.3: Investment and Savings Figure 1.4: Foreign Investment Inflow % of GDP Millions $US 25 5500 20 National Savings Portfolio FDI 15 3500 Private Investment 10 Public Investment 1500 5 0 FY01 FY02 FY03 FY04 FY05 FY06 FY07 FY08 FY09 -500 FY03 FY04 FY05 FY06 FY07 FY08 FY09 Source: Pakistan Economic Survey 2008-09. 3. The compensation of growth was notably uneven across sectors and size groups. The large scale manufacturing sector led growth during the first half of the decade, but slowed down considerably thereafter due initially to capacity and infrastructure constraints and later by the collapse in external demand. (Figure 1.5 and 1.6). The early part of decade saw the easy access to consumer financing spurring production of domestic consumer durables, electronics, autos, food stuffs, and cement led the growth of domestic oriented manufacturing, Agriculture also rebounded during the period, from little expansion to almost 6 percent growth in FY05/06, before slowing down in FY07/08. The services sector- banking, telecommunications, domestic trade and construction, catering primarily to the domestic demand grew steadily throughout the decade, and contributed increasingly to output and employment Figure 1.5: Growth in the Components of GDP Figure 1.6: Manufacturing Growth Rates by Size 20 25 Agriculture 15 Manufacturing 20 Large scale Small scale Services 15 10 10 5 5 0 0 FY03 FY04 FY05 FY06 FY07 FY08 FY09 FY03 FY04 FY05 FY06 FY07 FY08 FY09 -5 -5 -10 Source: Pakistan Economic Survey 2008-09. 4. The economic expansion was in part fueled by heavy reliance on external financing and expansionary fiscal stance, compounded by loose monetary policy. High inflows of confessional financing coupled with liberal financial sector policies led to a sharp increase in aggregate demand and overheating of the economy. Bolstered by an overvalued exchange rate, imports sharply rose—the yearly amount almost doubled between FY04 and FY07. (Table 1.1). More importantly, the turnaround from a current account surplus of 4.7 percent of GDP in FY03 to the account deficit of 4.8 percent of GDP in FY07 was dramatic. Table 1.1: Trade Balance, FY01-09 FY Imports Exports Trade Balance FY01 10.7 9.2 -1.5 FY02 10.3 9.1 -1.2 FY03 12.2 11.2 -1.1 FY04 15.6 12.3 - 3.3 FY05 20.6 14.4 - 6.2 FY06 28.6 16.5 -12.1 FY07 30.5 17.0 -13.5 FY08 39.9 19.1 -16.8 FY09 34.8 17.7 -17.1 Source: Federal Bureau of Statistics, GOP. 5. The accommodating policy response, in combination with the surge in world commodity prices, created large deficits and left the economy vulnerable to external shocks. At the same time, political turmoil made an adequate response to the shocks more difficult. The oil and wheat import bills increased by 56 and 46 percent, respectively, and raised the total the 2 import bill by about 31 percent. Since in parallel, export growth slowed down, the trade and current account deficits widened to 8.4 and 9.1 percent of GDP, respectively by end FY08. (Table 1.2). At the same time, primarily because the government did not pass on the international commodity price increases to consumers and therefore increased subsidies, the fiscal deficit increased sharply to 7.4 percent of GDP, almost double the budget target. This sharp erosion in Pakistan’s fiscal and external position caused a loss in investor confidence, a rapid rise in Pakistan international bond spreads, an outflow of portfolio investments, and downgrades by credit rating agencies.5 Donor inflows as well significantly dropped as the macroeconomic framework went off track. Table 1.2: Macroeconomic Indicators, FY05-09 FY05 FY06 FY07 FY08 FY09 Inflation (%) 4.6 9.3 7.8 7.8 11 Fiscal deficit (% of GDP) 3.3 4.3 4.3 7.4 5.2 Current Account (% of GDP) 1.6 4.4 4.8 8.4 5.6 Trade Deficit (% of GDP) 4.0 6.5 6.6 9.1 7.6 External Debt (bn US$) 35.9 39.0 41.6 44.5 50.8 Exchange rate (Rs/US$) 58.3 60.3 69.7 75.6 80.6 Forex Reserves (bn US$) 9.8 10.7 14.3 8.6 9.1 Source: Pakistan Economic Survey 2008-09. Staff Estimates 6. Pakistan foreign reserves declined rapidly due to the large current account deficit, a reduction in net capital inflows, and inadequate adjustment of the exchange rate. By November 2008, the foreign exchange reserves of the central bank had dropped to about three weeks of import cover, and the nominal exchange rate was steadily depreciating. Faced with lower external financing and privatization receipts, the government had resorted to borrowing from the central bank for budget deficit financing. This monetization fueled inflation, which rose well above 20 percent. At the same time, real interest rates turned negative as the nominal interest rates were inadequately adjusted. (Figure 1.7) Figure 1.7: Key macroeconomic Indicators Exchange rate Inflation Money and interest rates 100.0 42 25 25 Broad Money CPI Real 36 20 Real Interest Rates 20 WPI 90.0 Non-food, Non-oil CPI 15 15 P ercen ta g e a n n u a l ch a n g e 30 R ea l In terest R a te (% ) M o n ey G ro w th (% ) 80.0 Nominal 10 10 24 In d ex 5 5 70.0 18 0 0 12 Jul- Dec- May- Oct- Mar- Aug- Jan- Jun- Nov- Apr- Sep- Feb- Jul- Dec- May- Oct- 60.0 -5 02 02 03 03 04 04 05 05 05 06 06 07 07 07 08 08 -5 6 -10 -10 50.0 0 Jul-02 Jan-03 Jul-03 Jan-04 Jul-04 Jan-05 Jul-05 Jan-06 Jul-06 Jan-07 Jul-07 Jan-08 Jul-08 Jul-03 Nov-03 Mar-04 Jul-04 Nov-04 Mar-05 Jul-05 Nov-05 Mar-06 Jul-06 Nov-06 Mar-07 Jul-07 Nov-07 Mar-08 Jul-08 -15 -15 Source: Global Economic Monitor. Source: Federal Bureau of Statistics, GOP Source: State Bank of Pakistan, GOP. 5 The EMBI Global Bond spread of Pakistani sovereign bonds rose close to 700 bp in FY08 and further to over 2,000 bp in the first half of FY09 as investor confidence plummeted. Pakistan’s risk rating was downgraded in May 2008, September/October 2008 and November 2008, by Standard & Poor’s and Moody’s due to the erosion in Pakistan’s external liquidity position and poor financing prospects. 3 7. In response to the macroeconomic instability, political uncertainty and deteriorating security, the economy has started to adjust through a slowdown in economic growth. However, in recent years, the volatility of growth, both on the high and the slower side or recent years, is reflected Figure 1.8: Export Growth Rates primarily through the large exporting enterprises (see 25.0 Figure 1.6). In particular at the beginning of and 20.0 through the middle of the decade, the large textile, 15.0 garment; chemicals, and sports goods boomed and 10.0 Percentage exports grew annually at double digit rates from 5.0 2002/03 to 2005/06, averaging an annual growth rate of 0.0 FY96 FY98 FY00 FY02 FY04 FY06 FY08 16 percent over the period. Since then, export growth -5.0 averaged around 4 percent growth in FY07 with a one -10.0 year rebound in FY08 (Figure 1.8). During FY09, -15.0 exports recorded a 6 percent contraction which is Source: Federal Bureau of Statistics, GOP. expected to continue in FY10, but at a lower rate. 8. To avoid balance of payments difficulties, the government’s stabilization program was supported by an International Monetary Fund Stand-By Arrangement in November 2008. The program called for fiscal and monetary tightening and curbing of monetization of government debt to bring down inflation, reduce the fiscal and external current account deficits to sustainable levels, and build up the foreign exchange reserves. Over the medium term, with the stabilization of the economy, the government envisages economic growth to gradually recover. Aided by increasing public investment—among other things in power and transport—gross capital formation is projected to rise and contribute to growth recovery and facilitate private sector activity over the medium term. However, the global economic crisis complicated the recovery, posing significant downside risk to the outlook particularly with the uncertainty in Pakistan’s external environment. B. Structural Issues 9. Pakistan’s uneven economic performance can also be viewed against the backdrop of its narrow and domestically oriented industrial base grounded in low value added production. The manufacturing base, considered the backbone of an economy, is still weak. The share of manufacturing in GDP in Pakistan is just 18.9 percent (Table 1.3), barely comparable with the relative performance of the sector in economies like South Korea, Indonesia, Malaysia, which also started industrializing in the 1960s. In the past five years, manufacturing and services as a share of GDP has increased vis-à-vis agriculture. In terms of capital investment, manufacturing is the predominant sector attracting almost 25 percent of total capital formation. It is followed by transportation, telecommunication and agriculture which account for 23 percent and 9 percent of total capital formation, respectively. However, the overall share of manufacturing is still lean by international standards. Table 1.3: Sector Share of GDP, FY01-09 (Percent) Sector FY01 FY02 FY03 FY04 FY05 FY06 FY07 FY08 FY09 Industry 23.8 23.7 23.6 25.5 26.3 25.9 26.3 25.7 24.3 Of which: Manufacturing 15.7 15.9 16.3 17.3 18.3 18.8 19.0 19.2 18.2 Agriculture 24.9 24.1 24.0 22.9 22.4 22.5 21.9 21.3 21.8 Services 51.3 52.1 52.4 51.6 51.3 51.7 51.8 53.0 53.8 Source: Pakistan Economic Survey 2008-09. 4 10. Pakistan’s economy was traditionally built around cotton and its current manufacturing base is still predominantly concentrated in textiles. Out of a total half million manufacturing establishments, textile wearing apparel and leather industries account for 43 percent of all firms, followed by food, beverage and tobacco establishments which make up a fifth of the manufacturing sector. Other important sectors within manufacturing are sports goods, cutlery, surgical instruments, electronics, and automobiles. The number of firms involved in manufacturing fabricated metal products, machinery and equipment and basic metal industries account for another 11 percent of manufacturing. Most of firms are stuck in a low value addition niche and are oriented primarily for domestic consumption and basic commodity-based exports. 11. Pakistan’s export basket is even more highly concentrated than its domestic production. Textiles account for half of all exports, and garments for another quarter. Food and leather products make up 10 and 4 percent of exports, respectively. In total, 45 products account for about 83 percent of exports, out of which 10 account for over 50 percent of total exports.6 Most of these products are from the textiles and garments sector. This stagnation in export concentration is a reflection of non-competitiveness, low firm productivity and weak positioning in international markets. The level of technology of Pakistan’s manufacturing sector is relatively low compared to that of other countries in Asia and the country’s ‘export complexity’ and competitiveness is at the same level or falling over the past two decades.7 12. The role of services in Pakistan’s economy has expanded over the years, particularly in recent times. The increasing sophistication, global orientation and overall formalization of the economy along with the rise in per capita income and corporate profits recent years, contributed to a greater demand for service providers. Most of the growth attributable to this phenomena has been in retail and wholesale trade, research and educational consultancy services, restaurants and hotels, financial services, construction, information technology (IT) and information technology enabled services (ITES), and professional services such as engineering, legal and accounting. However, the sector also supports a large number of small scale businesses run by livelihood-seekers catering to the local population. An example is the active and high demand hotels and restaurants sector consists of a few large hotels and dominated by smaller street-side establishments. 13. Based on the 2005 Economic Census, 95 percent of the 3.3 million operating economic establishments are in the private sector, but the average firm size is very small and informal. More than 90 percent of the enterprises are sole proprietorships and 2 percent are partnerships. A little over half are in wholesale and retail trade, a quarter in community and personal services, and a fifth in manufacturing. Most of the manufacturing, mining, agriculture, wholesale and retail, construction, and transportation enterprises are located in Punjab and Sindh, with Punjab accounting for the largest share of economic establishments, at two thirds, followed by Sindh (17 percent), NWFP (14 percent), and Baluchistan (2 percent) (Figure 1.9). 14. Almost 90 percent of the private enterprises are SMEs which employ 78 percent of the non-agricultural workforce and contribute 30 percent to the GDP. Ninety five percent of 6 At the 4 digit Harmonized System (HS) code level, from United Nations trade statistics, (COMTRADE). 7 Felipe 2007 (p. 28). 5 the 3.3 million economic establishments in Pakistan employ 1-5 persons each. Another 4 percent employ 6-50 persons each and only 1,617 establishments surveyed employ over 50 persons each. Manufacturing establishments show a slightly higher employment size but, even here, over 90 percent of the manufacturing establishments reported employing 1-5 persons each, 9 percent employ 6-50 persons each, and 1,122 firms employ over 50 workers. Of the 1.6 million establishments in wholesale retail trade, and hotels and restaurants, 99 percent are micro establishments, employing 1-5 persons each. Figure 1.9: Economic and Provincial Structure of Pakistan’s Enterprise Sector: 2005 By economic activity By province Agri, Forestry, Mining & Hunting & Quarrying fishing Baluchistan NWFP Community & Manufacturing Social Services Finance, Electricity, Insurance, Gas & Water Real Estate Sindh Trade, Hotels, Construction Punjab Transport, Storage Restaurants Source: Pakistan Economic Census 2005. C. Key Challenges Ahead 15. As Pakistan recovers from economic crisis and attempts to stabilize the economy, the economic volatility, uncertainty and the global financial crises dominate the country’s investment climate. A high degree of certainty regarding the future path of prices, exchange rates and interest rates are key dimensions of a country’s investment climate which influence a firm’s long range investment planning, daily business management and decisions about risk taking. The uncertainty that accompanies macroeconomic volatility is itself an important determinant of firm behavior affecting investment, productivity and growth. Globalization, while providing a great opportunity, is also making the challenge of providing a stable macroeconomic environment more complex, as manifested dramatically by the impact of the recent global financial turmoil. 16. The significant steps needed to return to macroeconomic stability present an opportunity to address the structural imbalances which to underpin stability and foster economic growth. With medium term growth dependent of a revival in private sector activity and a sustain export growth, the competitiveness of domestic production now has the full attention of the authorities. The ambitious adjustment path in terms of its proposed fiscal adjustment and financial discipline envisioned, recognizes the need to regain, retain and sustain macroeconomic stability by anchoring flexible exchange and interest rates with strong fiscal and monetary measures, It also is balanced by recognizing a need for accommodating changes in key relative prices—particularly the real effective exchange real interest rate as well as in taxation. 6 17. Under these circumstances in particular, increased productivity and export competitiveness will be necessary to generate growth and reduce external vulnerability over time. The economic recovery and projected medium-term growth path requires that private sector activity pick up and that exports will rise over time, assuming bold action is taken to enhance the orientation of the domestic incentives regime, (ii) eliminating systematic discrimination against industry in pricing and taxation (iii) strengthen the investment climate and the competitive environment. Required are measures to ease firm entry and exit, reduce barriers to competition and trade, deepen factor markets and strengthen market governance. In addition, efforts to improve the financial sustainability and efficiency of the power sector will be essential to attract investment in new power generation. The subsequent chapters of the report focus on the third area—policies and programs to improvement investment climate as a key determinant of productivity and growth. 7 II. UNLEASHING SUSTAINED GROWTH OVER THE LONG RUN A. Unleashing Sustained Growth as the Central Pillar for Poverty Reduction 18. Raising per capita GDP growth ultimately requires increasing global competitiveness and the generation of demand for skilled employment; two pillars of the Government’s poverty reduction strategy. Pakistan’s Vision 2030 which seeks to achieve middle income status of around $US 4,000 per capita in the coming two decades by developing human resources and necessary physical and technical infrastructure, remains the medium term vision of the Government. However, the current environment focuses shorter term of regaining macroeconomic stability, maintaining employment levels and returning growth to 5-7 percent over the next five years. 19. The fundamental driver behind the growth needed to underpin these objectives is growth in labor productivity. The decomposition of GDP per capita provides insight into the large role played by productivity in explaining inter-country differences over time (Figure 2.1). Simply, by identity, differences between countries in GDP per capita can be decomposed into differences in labor force participation, labor productivity and the age composition of the population.8 Empirically, labor productivity accounts for the bulk of the gap in GDP per capita. Moreover, the larger the gap in GDP per capita, the more, labor productivity accounts for the difference. Figure 2.1: Decomposition of Differences in GDP per Capita In comparison with In comparison with In comparison with South Asia East Asia United States Labor force Labor force participation participation Age Labor force composition participation Labor Age composition productivity Labor Labor productivity productivity Age composition Source: World Development Indicators. 20. Over time, even with Pakistan’s high labor participation, changes in Pakistan’s GDP per capita have been dominated by variations in labor productivity. The pattern of growth in these three variables is seen by tracking the ratio of GDP per capita in selected countries against East Asia (Figure 2.2). The figure makes it clear that labor productivity is the most important contributor to the gap in per capita income between countries. Pakistan increased its labor force participation relative to East Asia in the later years, but still, the GDP per capita gap rose due to the rising labor productivity gap over time. In 2006, Pakistan’s labor productivity was slightly higher than South Asia’s but considerably lower than that of the East Asia Region (Figure 2.3). 8 GDP per capita*= Labor productivity; * Labor force participation; * Age composition of the population Labor force participation means the proportion of the working age population which is employed or unemployed, and age composition of the population refers to the proportion of the population which is of working age. 8 Figure 2.2: Evolution of GDP Per Capita in Pakistan and Selected Economies with Respect to East Asia, 1990-2006 GDP per capita (relative to EAP), constant 2000 $ 140 120 100 percentage 80 60 40 Bangladesh India 20 Indonesia Pakistan China 0 1991 1992 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 250 GDP per worker (relative to EAP), constant 2000 $ Bangladesh India Indonesia 200 Pakistan China 150 percentage 100 50 0 1991 1992 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 Labor force participation (relative to EAP), constant 2000 $ 120 110 100 percentage Bangladesh 90 India Indonesia Pakistan 80 China 70 60 1991 1992 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 Source: The World Bank, World Development Indicators, 2008. 9 Figure 2.3: Labor Productivity Comparisons Value added per worker (Bangladesh = 100) 340 260 180 100 China India Pakistan East Asia & South Asia Pacific Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007, World Bank 2008. 21. Labor productivity is decomposed into two growth terms: increasing capital deepening9 and gains in total factor productivity.10 Total factor productivity at the firm level reflects the contribution of firm specific factors such as investment in technology adoption, upgrading of labor force skills, proprietary knowledge and as described below, adaptation to other investment climate dimensions. Due partly to the high labor force participation in Pakistan, labor productivity in Pakistan grew slower than in South Asia and particularly East Asia through the lower capital intensity growth. Growth in total factor productivity was comparable to other South Asian countries, though slightly lower than the average, owing to India’s high TFP growth over the period. However, as shown in the next, lower capital intensity of production, is not due to low investment, but rather the rapid increase in the labor participation rates, which places a much higher burden on maintaining growth in investment through increasing of TFP, than for other countries. Figure 2.4: Labor Productivity Growth Decomposition in Selected Economies, 2001-2006 4 Labor productivity growth Contribution of capital intensity growth Contribution of TFP growth 3 Percentage growth 2001/06 2 1 0 India Bangladesh Indonesia Pakistan East Asia & Pacific South Asia Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007, World Bank 2008. 9 Capital deepening means here, higher capital output ratios, based on higher investment rates relative to labor growth. 10 Numerous articles in economic literature attribute differences in output per worker between rich and poor countries to TFP. See Caselli (2005), Hall & Jones (1999), and Klenow & Rodríguez-Clare (1997). 10 22. Like other countries, factor accumulation, was the primary source of growth in Pakistan over the past five decades with growth periods coinciding with higher productivity. Long-term growth has averaged around 5 percent since 1960 but the record has been volatile. In general, periods of higher growth coincided with higher TFP—particularly in the 1980s and 2000s—which in turn, coincided with macro stability, microeconomic reforms and political certainty. The most recent example of this is the growth episode was in the early 2000 period, when TFP growth accounted for a quarter of the 2002-2006 growth rates. (Figure 2.5). Still, although Pakistan’s higher than average growth was more capital intensive than that of its neighbors it still falls short of the type of growth East Asia experienced. Recent growth analysis estimates suggest that Pakistan would need to raise the investment rate well above the current rate of around 17 percent of GDP to rates of around 27-29 percent, in order to realize a return to steady episodes of 7 percent growth.11 Figure 2.5: Growth Accounting, 1960-2005 By year By country 7% GDP growth capital labor TFP 7% GDP growth capital labor TFP 6% 6% 5% 5% 4% 4% 3% 3% 2% 2% 1% 1% 0% 0% 1960s 1970s 1980s 1990s 2000 - 05 Pakistan India Bangladesh East Asia Source: The World Bank, Growth and Export Competitiveness, 2006. * Note: Average growth rates are calculated up to year 2003 except for Pakistan up to 2005. 23. At the firm level, the Olley Pakes (O&P) methodology distinguishes between average productivity and aggregate industry wide productivity.12 Dynamic aspects of efficiency resulting from entry and exist are difficult to observe, since the data needed to examine ‘churning effects’ is not available. Instead, the static analysis uses an Olley-Pakes methodology to decompose aggregate productivity into two terms: (i) the productivity of the average firm (average productivity), and (ii) the weighting effect (allocative efficiency) which reflects the distribution of the average productivity across firms of various market shares. Attention to the allocation 11 The World Bank, Growth and Export Competitiveness, 2006. 12 According to the Olley-Pakes (O&P) decomposition: (i) average productivity is the efficiency of the average or representative firm of the industry, and (ii) aggregate productivity is the weighted average of firm level productivities, where the weights are firms’ shares of sales and productivity. In calculating productivity for a sector, therefore, higher value is given to productivity of firms with larger market shares. The term allocative efficiency is, by construction, the difference between aggregate productivity and average productivity, reflecting the allocation of market share according to firm level productivity—or in other words, the first level covariance effect between productivity and the firm’s market share. This is, in general, a widely accepted proxy for firm level efficiency. If the allocative efficiency is zero, then either all the firms have the same level of productivity, or all the firms have the same share of sales, or both. If the allocative efficiency is positive, then high productive firms have larger market sales than low productive firms. 11 effects is important, particularly for Pakistan, as wide dispersions of productivities are observed even within narrowly defined industries.13 24. The allocative efficiency term, in a static sense, represents distributional aspects of productivity differences among firms of different sizes and market shares. A large term reflects high productivity firms co-existing with low productivity firms and therefore opportunity for gains from resource reallocation. A large positive term reflects high association of the high productivity firms with high market shares, providing evidence of an allocative efficiency which “allocates� productivity (either from an efficiency or market dominance angle) to firms with high market share. Regardless, it is fair to say that a positive allocative efficiency on term is likely superior to a situation with a large negative term for the purposes of allocative efficiency. 25. The high variance of firm level productivity embodied in the allocative efficiency term may also reflect market frictions that enable low productivity/low market share firms to exist without exit. In other words, in a frictionless economy, the allocative efficiency term of the O&P decomposition may equal zero, since productive establishments will take all market share. Nonetheless, frictions arise which prevent this theoretical outcome. Frictions may arise from a variety of causes, including the adjustment costs of entry and exit, difficulties in contract enforcement, lack of property rights enforcement, poor retail systems, competition issues, market structure, or technological factors. These frictions in an economy are part of the investment climate for doing business and impact the efficiency of an average firm in a given country but they can also help explain the existence and role of a large allocative efficiency term. 26. These allocation factors are especially important in Pakistan, as compared to other countries. International comparisons show that Pakistan has a very large allocative efficiency term in the late 2000s (Figure 2.6). The large allocation term not only supports the hypotheses of resource allocation toward higher productivity firms, but also of a duality in the economy14 where formal and (relatively) high-productive firms coexist with smaller, informal, low productive firms. The positive allocation term indicates that at least most of the resources are being used by the top ranked firms in terms of average productivity. However, the coexistence of a high efficiency term with a low average productivity term shows that the low productivity firms dominate in terms of numbers but not in terms of market shares. Traditionally, aggregate productivity in a dual economy is depressed as too many resources are allocated to low productivity production in the informal sector. 13 Productivity analysis has commonly focused on differences in technical efficiency within representative firms (or average productivity). See, for example, Howitt (2000), and Klenow and Rodríguez-Clare (2005). However, empirical attempts at capturing allocative efficiency results from the recognition that competitiveness involves not only average productivity levels but also how resources are allocated among heterogeneous plants. A healthy market mechanism encourages resources to move to more productive firms with the static result being that more productive businesses have larger market shares. See, studies by Baily, Hulten and Campbell (1992), Bartelsman, Haltiwanger, and Scarpetta (2004), Foster, Haltiwanger, and Krizan (2006), Olley and Pakes (1996), Alfaro et.al. (2007), Olley and Pakes, 1996, Griliches and Regev 1995, and Foster Haltiwanger and Krizan, 2001, 2002. 14 Dual economy theory refers advanced, capital-intensity sectors coexisting with comparatively poor, traditional labor intensively sectors (Boeke, 1953; Lewis, 1954; Hirschman, 1958). The debate traditionally focuses on economic growth being achieved through capital-intensive and more innovative sectors versus resources being distributed through the economy for a more balanced growth. The lack of feedback mechanisms between both sectors limits gains in average productivity. See for example, Gopinath, Roe and Shane, 1996, Blunch and Verner, 1996; Martin and Mitra, 1998; Krueger, Schiff, and Valdes, 1992, Vollrath (2008 and J H Boeke, 1953). 12 Figure 2.6: International Comparison of Allocative Efficiency Term Share of allocative efficiency on aggregate log-productivity 50 40 Percentage 30 20 10 0 Sout Africa Bangladesh Croatia Indonesia Chile Mexico Brazil India Philippines Pakistan Source: Estimates from Investment Climate Surveys. 27. The productivity distribution in Pakistan is asymmetric and less spread when compared with a standard normal, and has two parts.15 Most of the density mass consists of low values of productivity—Area I in Figure 2.7—with another smooth and smaller density peak in Area II, representing the formalized and high productivity firms. This distribution of productivities provides an opportunity for: (i) bringing the technical efficiency of less productive firms closer to the more productive ones in Area 2, and (ii) reallocating resources across plants. Both lead to an increase in aggregate productivity (Figure 2.7). In the first scenario, a hypothetical increase in the technical efficiency of the firms in Area 1 would cause a symmetric displacement of productivity density towards the right. In the second scenario, when less productive businesses in Area 1 exit the market, the productivity distribution moves towards the right to a greater extent than in the previous case, provided that the lower level of productivity in the population is that of firms of Area 2 (Figure 2.8). Consequently, resources released by exiting firms are used by more efficient plants, translating to welfare gains for the economy. Figure 2.7: Kernel Estimate of Productivity Density Figure 2.8: Changes in the Productivity Distribution Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 15 Kernel density estimation is a non-parametric way of estimating the probability density function of a random variable. In other words, given some data about a sample of a population, kernel density estimation makes it possible to extrapolate the data to the entire population. 13 28. Analysis of the enterprise surveys of 2002 and 2007 suggests that aggregate productivity in Pakistan’s manufacturing sector increased over the period.16 The observed increase in productivity was due mainly to the allocation becoming more biased toward larger market share firms and only marginally due to a rise in the term measuring average productivity. This indicates that although there was a process of reallocation of market share toward higher productivity firms, low-productive firms lost market share but did not exit the market and suppressed the ‘average firm’ productivity term. The increase in aggregate productivity is observed for the both the two datasets and confirmed by extracting a non-representative panel sample of 400 firms which were surveyed twice (Figure 2.9). The increase was due to both to increases in firm level productivity as well economy wide productivity gains resulting from market shares going to firms with higher levels of productivity. Figure 2.9: Aggregate and Average TFP Over Time Total manufacturing sample Panel portion of manufacturing sample 2.0 2.0 Aggregate productivity Average productivity Efficiency term Aggregate productivity Average productivity Efficiency term 1.5 1.5 T F P in lo g s TFP in logs 1.0 1.0 0.5 0.5 0.0 0.0 1999 2000 2001 2004 2005 1999 2000 2001 2004 2005 Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 29. The change in the productivity distribution over the 2002-07 period indicates slightly less concentration of low productivity firms in 2007 than in 2002. The observation as graphed as kernel density graphs for the two samples periods of FY02 and FY07 that the average productivity distribution of firms is moving to higher Figure 2.10: Kernel Density for Productivity, productivity areas supports a dynamic analysis of FY02 and FY07 rising firm level productivity (Figure 2.10). The results show clearly the high concentration of low 1 productivity firms which characterizes Pakistan’s .8 enterprise sector. It underscores the results described .6 Density above which imply low average productivity and a high range of productivity differences among co- .4 existing firms. This migration of firms towards more .2 productive areas of the frequency distribution is also 0 fully consistent with the increase of average -2 0 2 Productivity 4 6 productivity observed in the O&P decomposition. Productivity FY07 Productivity FY02 Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 16 Caution should be used when interpreting productivity purely as efficiency. There is debate in the field regarding whether productivity should be better viewed as firm-level revenue generation power which consists both of using factors more efficiency, (i.e. technical efficiency) resulting from firm specific investment in technology, competition, labor skills, etc on the one coupled with firm specific market power that allows a firm’s own prices to be raised in relation to the sector deflators being used. In this analysis, distinction is not possible, so that the term productivity is used to cover both. 14 30. Over time, the analysis implies that large firms were more productive than small and medium firms, and older firms gained more allocative efficiency than younger firms. When one looks at the productivity levels on average, large firms are only slightly more efficient that the average small or medium firm. However, when taking into account the allocative efficiency effects, the productivity differences are larger. When looking at the firms’ age, the difference in the two transmission mechanisms is even greater. On average, old firms are about as productive as new firms but in terms of distributional aspects, the allocative efficiency is much higher for the old firms than for the young firms (Figure 2.11). Therefore for older firms, high productivity firms are associated with firms commanding a relatively high market share, reflecting an ability of those firms to generate higher revenues for given inputs. This relationship holds for older firms to a greater degree than younger ones and may represent biases against innovative younger firms and frictions in the entry/exit mechanism. Figure 2.11: Aggregate and Average Productivity, 2007 By firm size By age of the firm 2.5 Aggregate productivity Average productivity Efficiency term 2.0 TFP in logs 1.5 1.0 0.5 0.0 Small Medium Large Young Old (<25 employees) (>=25 & <100 (>=100 (<5 years) (>=5 years) employees) employees) By province 2.5 Aggregate productivity Average productivity Efficiency term 2.0 TFP in logs 1.5 1.0 0.5 0.0 Punjab Sindh Baluchistan NWFP Whole Pakistan Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 31. Firms in Sindh, dominated by the larger and more established firms of Karachi, have higher levels of average productivity and allocative efficiency than other provinces. This pattern is also consistent with the view that higher market shares, and the associated higher levels of productivity, rest with the group of larger, older firms as opposed to the group young and small firms (Figure 1.21). Apart from the results from Sindh firms, average firm level 15 productivity does not differ as much across provinces, but differences are seen in the allocative efficiency term. Therefore, while Punjab has the second highest aggregate productivity but due to the allocative efficiency effect of larger market share firms as compared to Baluchistan and particularly NWFP, where average productivity did not differ as much across firms. B. The Investment Climate’s Role in Supporting Pakistan’s Growth Agenda 32. The investment climate plays a critical and determining role in supporting the two forces driving Pakistan’s development strategy. As articulated in Pakistan’s poverty reduction strategy these forces are: (i) increase in firm level efficiency, and (ii) creation of high quality jobs and increasing employment for the high proportion of the working age population. In both cases, the investment climate plays a critical role through the transmission mechanisms depicted in Figure 2.12. An improved investment climate has the effect of increasing employment and efficiency of the firm by: (i) directly increasing productivity, (ii) increasing market competition, and (iii) decreasing the degree of informality. Figure 2.12: The Investment Climate’s Transmission Channels Globalization effects Labor force effects GLOBALIZATION EFFECTS (I): Improving efficiency at the firm level  LABOR FORCE EFFECTS: Improve labor markets  GDP per  GDP per capita  capita  All economy labor  Sector labor  Labor force  productivity  productivities  participation  Unemployment rate  INDUSTRY LEVEL  Working age population­ Hours worked per  Within industry  total population ratio  employee  aggregate TFP  Labor markets  Within  Within industry  industry  allocative  average TFP  efficiency  Real wages per  Labor Demand  employee  WITHIN FIRM  ENVIRONMENT  TFP at firm level  TFP at firm level  Market shares  INVESTMENT   CLIMATE  DIRECT EFFECTS  LEVEL OF COMPETITION  LEVEL OF INFORMAL ITY  DIRECT EFFECTS  LEVEL OF COMPETITION  LEVEL OF INFORMAL ITY  Power supply  Access and  Regulatory burden:  Crime and  Power supply  Access and  Regulatory burden:  Crime and  Water supply  cost of  Customs & trade  disorder  Water supply  cost of  Customs & trade  disorder  Trade logistics  finance  regulations  Corruption of  Trade logistics  finance  regulations  Corruption of  Telecoms.  Labor regulations  public officials  Telecoms.  Labor regulations  public officials  ICT  Business licenses  ICT  Business licenses  Labor skills  Operating permits  Labor skills  Operating permits  Innovation  Innovation  Legal system  Legal system  16 33. Several individual and country studies show that the quality of the investment climate is positively associated with productivity, growth and poverty.17 As an empirical exercise, the positive correlation between demean aggregate productivity18 (a proxy of the investment climate effect on productivity) and the business environment (as proxied by Figure 2.13: Relationship Between Income, Demean the Doing Business Rankings 2008) Productivity and the Business Environment can be clearly seen in cross-country By GDP per capita regressions (Figure 2.13). This 6.0 figure shows that large and positive investment climate effects on CHL 5.0 Demean average productivity average productivity are associated 4.0 with larger income per capita and y = 5.6x + 0.5 R2 = 0.49 ease of doing business. It illustrates 3.0 ZAF how the social and political 2.0 BRA MEX HRV arrangements (investment climate) 1.0 BGD PAK IND that a society employs in the PHL IDN TUR production of goods and services, 0.0 0.0 0.1 0.1 0.2 0.2 0.3 0.3 0.4 0.4 0.5 0.5 dramatically impacts the society’s GDP per capita (relative to U.S) living standards. Other multi-country Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007 and Penn World Table data. studies show that the investment climate has a direct and significant By doing business indicators impact on TFP and growth. Recent 6.0 cross country estimates imply that if 5.0 CHL Pakistan made significant Demean average productivity improvements in its education, 4.0 infrastructure and financial depth to 3.0 y = 0.4x + 0.8 R2 = 0.33 reach the top 25 percent of 2.0 ZAF developing county levels, the BRA HRV MEX BGD PAK IND country’s per capita GDP would 1.0 PHL increase by more than two and half 0.0 IDN TUR times over what it was in the 2001- 0.0 1.0 2.0 3.0 Rank on the ease of doing business 4.0 5.0 6.0 05 period.19 Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007.and Doing Business Report 2007. 34. Firm level data from Pakistan also shows that a large positive correlation between productivity and employment with facets of the country’s investment climate. As the aggregate log-productivity can be split into average log-productivity and allocative efficiency, symmetrically we can compute the IC contributions on both terms. Based on the econometric estimations described in more detail below, the investment climate in Pakistan explains 11 percent of average productivity differences among firms, which is amplified to 41 percent for 17 See Bosworth and Collins, 2003; Dollar et al., 2004; Rodrik and Subramanian, 2004; Loayza, Oviedo and Serven, 2004; McMillan, 1998 and 2004; OECD, 2001; Wilkinson, 2001; Alexander et al., 2004; Djankov et al., 2002; Haltiwanger, 2002; He et al., 2003; World Bank, 2003; World Bank, 2004 a, b; World Bank 2005; Prescott, 1998; Cole et al, 2004; Escribano and Guasch 2005 and 2008; Escribano et al., 2008 a, b, c and d. 18 The part of productivity explained or influenced by the investment climate is referred to as demean productivity, as in Escribano et al (2008c), and allows international comparisons. 19 The World Bank, Pakistan: Growth and Export Competitiveness, 2007. 17 aggregate productivity due to the high allocative efficiency term.20 The estimations show that over two-thirds of the variations in average employment are explained by the investment climate. Figure 2.14: Share of Productivity and Employment Explained by the Investment Climate By average productivity By aggregate productivity By average employment Other IC Wage Other IC TFP IC Other Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 35. The statistical relationship between the investment climate variables and productivity is positive, but due mostly to the allocative term rather than through average firm productivity. Pakistan’s demand aggregate productivity—meaning the part of productivity affected by the investment climate—is comparable with that of Mexico and South Africa, lower than that of Chile and Brazil, and higher than that of other countries in the region and even in Asia (such as, Indonesia, Turkey and the Philippines),21 underscoring the investment climate’s positive impact22 (Figure 2.15). However, in Pakistan the investment climate’s contribution to aggregate productivity is made prominent by the fact that the investment climate has a negligible and marginal impact on average productivity. This market characteristic is observed strongly in Brazil and Pakistan and to a lesser extent in India and Bangladesh. On the other hand, countries like Chile, Mexico and South Africa derive their high levels of aggregate productivity growth from business conditions which raise average productivity of the representative firm. 20 Productivity at the firm level is expressed as logP=a0+ai+ar+as+b*IC+e, where a0 is the constant term, ai, ar and as are respectively sector, region and size fixed effects, and e is an error term. The share of the IC on firm level productivity is simply (b*IC/logP)*100, and the share of the other stuff is [(a0+ai+ar+as+e)/logP]*100. By aggregating those expressions according to the O&P decompositions, we get the share of the IC on average log-P and on the allocative efficiency. The empirical approach consists of a structural model that relates the conditional expectation of productivity with more than 140 investment climate and 30 control variables productivity in logs or in levels., following Escribano et al (2008) and uses productivity in logs, to apply additive properties. (See appendix on econometric methods). 21 To avoid the problems of direct comparison of productivity across countries, demean productivity is used to enable cross-country comparisons. The demean productivity is the portion of productivity which is explained by the investment climate. In Pakistan’s case, the proportion of average productivity explained by the investment climate is around 11 percent, while for aggregate productivity the number is amplified to 41 percent. 22 Caution is advised in inferring conclusions when making comparisons here—as this only maps the association between productivity and IC and puts the aggregate results in perspective with other countries using the same methodology. However, the interrelationship between investment climate and firms’ performance is too complicated and involves too many interrelationships to try to summarize all of them in a single figure. Instead, we think that the comparison is very useful as it puts our results in perspective and provides us with a starting point to begin our analysis. 18 Figure 2.15: Aggregate and Average Demean Log-Productivity Across Countries 2.0 Aggregate productivity Average productivity Allocative efficiency 1.5 1.0 TFP in logs 0.5 0.0 -0.5 -1.0 Philippines Turkey Indonesia Bangladesh India Croatia Mexico Pakistan South Brazil Chile Africa Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. Note: The productivity measure used is the demean restricted Solow residual in logs. See appendix on econometric methods for more details. C. Determining Priorities in the Investment Climate 36. Priority areas in the investment climate are identified from empirical analysis and from asking firm managers—both imperfect and indirect, but yielding consistent results. The two approaches generally followed to assess the relative importance of various aspects of the investment climate involve: (i) measuring their empirical impact on desired outcomes—in this case productivity and employment, and (ii) drawing inferences from the perceptions of practitioners working in Pakistan.23 For the investment climate survey, managers of domestic firms working in Pakistan are asked their view of top constraints, both in absolute terms and ranked against one another. Later in the report, indicators of the identified constraints are benchmarked against other countries, within groups and across time. While the analytical framework is imperfect and require caution in strict interpretations, impressions and approximations taken from various perspectives provide robust direction for the report’s policy recommendations. 37. Specific investment climate priorities for Pakistan, as enunciated by firm managers, are relatively consistent with the FY02 responses but also show some dramatic changes. In particular, in 2002, most firms perceived the principal investment climate constraints to be infrastructure; red tape, bureaucracy and economic governance; access to finance and electricity; corruption; political instability; and macroeconomic instability. In 2007, they identified the constraints as electricity, macroeconomic instability, corruption, and political uncertainty. Clearly there is some commonality as infrastructure, governance and economic/political stability were and still are high on the minds of entrepreneurs (Figure 2.16). 23 While the information coming from managers’ perceptions is very useful, the econometric analysis provides more scientific insights on the actual investment climate conditions and the key bottleneck faced by firms as we start from a population structural model and draw conclusions by deduction from that model. In other words, we let data define the IC bottlenecks rather than subjective measures. 19 Figure 2.16: Percent of Firms Considering Obstacle as Major / Severe 80 2007 2002 70 60 50 40 30 20 10 0 availa bility insta bility insta bility reg ula tion s T ra nsp ort Lice nsin g an d E le ctricity T ax ra te s C rim e , the ft, C orrup tion A cce ss to lan d a dm in istra tion T e le co m com p etitive A ccess to P olitica l C usto m s an d re gu la tio ns fin an ce pra ctices M acro diso rde r L ab or S kill p erm its A n ti- tra de Tax 38. However, a comparison of the firms’ assessments of particular investment climate constraints over this period clearly reveals both successes and great challenges. In particular, the substantial deterioration in the power sector over Table 2.1: Percent of Firms Considering time is clear—the number of firms considering this Obstacle as Major / Severe to be major or severe constraint has doubled. Firms 2007 2002 also perceive governance, corruption, macro and Deterioration political instability, and crime and disorder to have Electricity 79.6 39.3 worsened considerably. On the other hand, in areas where the government has devoted resources Corruption 56.7 40.3 and policy attention—finance, tax administration, Macro instability 56.6 34.5 anti-competitive practices, labor regulations, and Political instability 46.8 40.4 customs and trade regulations—major Crime, theft, disorder 32.5 21.4 improvements are perceived by firms (Table 2.1). Improvements For instance, taxes and access to finance were Tax administration 23.2 47.0 perceived to be top constraints in 2002 but now Access to finance 17.6 38.3 rank much lower on the list—the number of firms Anti-competitive practices 14.1 21.4 considering these as major obstacles has halved over the five year period. Improvements in labor Labor regulations 5.9 15.8 and customs regulations have been even more Customs regulations 5.8 24.4 dramatic. Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2002 and 2007. 39. Empirically, the same top constraints perceived by firms in 2002 were also constraints to productivity growth. The key IC variables are identified through their impact on productivity and observed using an econometric estimation of a Probit model which examines the probability of productivity change given the investment climate conditions firms faced in FY02. In spite of the clear limitations implicit in this exercise, the interest is to have empirical evidence to support hypotheses about the factors behind positive productivity changes observed between FY02 and FY07.24 24 The Probit model applied in this exercise is based in a non-representative panel of 400 firms and cannot be extended to the entire population but rather the sub-sample is representing. Problems of simultaneity and omitted variables may also be presented. All the econometric issues are treated in detail in the econometric appendix. 20 40. A clear set of specific variables Table 2.2: Important Investment Climate Variables in appear to have had an important impact on 2002 Dependent variable: Prob. productivity change between 2002 and Explanatory IC variable of increased producivty 2007 These variables include: (i) number of Infrastructure Number of power outages - power outages and the low quality of power Low quality supplies - supply (on average, those firms that suffered Economic Security expenses + a larger number of power outages in FY02 governance Crime losses - reduced their productivity in FY07), (ii) the Manager’s time spent in - bureaucratic issues time, costs and hassles in complying with Number of inspections - regulations (productivity is unlikely to grow Informal payments to obtain a + in those firms in which the managers’ time contract with the government is spent dealing with bureaucracy or Illegal payments in protection - receiving more inspections), (iii) crime and Finance Dummy for credit line + security (higher losses due to crime are Dummy for loan + associated with lower increases in Dummy for loan with collateral + productivity; at the same time, investing in Dummy for trade association + security is associated with increases in Labor markets Staff-female workers - productivity), (iv) access to finance (those and skills Staff-university education + firms having access to a credit line, loan or Training to non-production + workers loan with collateral in FY02 increased productivity on average in FY07) and (v) Other variables Dummy for state owned firm + Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. training both formal and on the job (providing training is associated with gains in productivity from FY02-07) (Table 2.2). 41. The list of top constraints, as revealed by the firms interviewed in 2007, included electricity, followed by macro and political instability, corruption, tax rates, and crime. Traditional aspects of business—including business regulation, land, labor and capital markets, and infrastructure services other than power—were ranked lower in the list of possible investment climate constraints (Figure 2.17). Also, issues related to courts, access to land and tax administration, although not listed among the top three constraints, are nonetheless considered a problem by a significant proportion of firms. Figure 2.17: Most Important IC Constraints (Percentage of firms ranking constraint in top 3) 100 Manufacturing Services Percentage 75 50 25 0 instability regulations Transportation Electricity Tax rates Business Corruption Crime, theft and Finance administration Customs and Macroeconomic Courts Land Education Political Competitors permits Informal Labor instability Trade disorder Tax Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 21 42. The results of the 2007 Investment Climate Survey are consistent with the perceptions of other surveys such as the Global Competitiveness Report (GCR). In the latest GCR covering 2008, government instability, corruption, inefficient bureaucracy, and inflation are listed as primary constraints faced by the private sector in Pakistan (Table 2.3). Tax rates and regulation, access to finance, labor regulations, and foreign currency regulation—which were previously considered primary constraints—are now viewed as secondary to the above mentioned macroeconomic and governance issues. In addition, the lack of infrastructure and skilled labor force continue to be constraints to productivity growth. Table 2.3: Pakistan’s Ranking in the Global Competitiveness Index, 2008-09 Pakistan India China Bangladesh Global Competitiveness Index 92 48 34 107 1. Institutions 81 48 77 126 2. Infrastructure 72 67 52 120 3. Macroeconomic stability 101 108 7 87 4. Health and primary education 115 101 61 105 5. Higher education and training 116 55 78 126 6. Goods market efficiency 82 36 58 93 7. Labor market efficiency 113 96 55 76 8. Financial market sophistication 65 37 118 75 9. Technological readiness 89 62 73 125 10. Market size 28 3 2 36 11. Innovation and sophistication 78 26 50 111 Source: World Economic Forum, Global Competitiveness Index, 2008. 43. Power sector issues were overwhelmingly identified as the most serious obstacle facing Pakistan’s investment climate. More than three quarters of manufacturing firms consider power a major or severe obstacle, with 83 percent seeing it as one of the top three constraints. Other types of infrastructure—water supply, transport and telecommunications—were rated relatively less important in the list of potential investment climate constraints. The percentage of firms considering these issues as severe was only 16, 15 and 6 percent, respectively. 44. The macroeconomic, political and governance issues which underpin the country’s investment climate have become the second most important set of obstacles. Macroeconomic instability, political uncertainty, corruption, and crime/disorder were ranked as the top constraints after power. More than half of all manufacturing firms rated macroeconomic and or political instability as major obstacles. In the case of macroeconomic instability, 43 percent of firms consider it as one of their top 3 constraints. For political instability, a quarter of firms considered it in the top 3. Firms also considered corruption, crime and the courts to be major obstacles. Corruption, in particular, was listed as a major obstacle by more than half the firms surveyed and a third ranked it among the top three obstacles. A tenth of firms thought corruption was the number one constraint. It is also significant that a third of firms considered crime and disorder a severe or major obstacle, with almost a quarter placing it among the top three constraints. Finally, while only a small number of firms ranked courts among the top three constraints, over a third listed it as a serious constraint to the investment climate. 45. The top constraints facing service sector firms do not differ radically from manufacturing, though some differences are notable. Electricity was the top constraint but 22 relatively less important to services than to manufacturing—around a third of service firms ranked it as the number one constraint and 60 percent ranked it in the top three. On the other hand, access to land was more important to service firms than to manufacturing—half the service firms ranked it an important obstacle and a quarter put it among the top three. Similarly, crime, corruption and the courts were relatively more important to services than to manufacturing. A third of service firms ranked crime or corruption as the top constraint, compared to 12 percent of manufacturing firms. 46. Small and medium enterprises rank investment climate constraints in generally the same order and with similar levels of concern as large firms. The principal difference is that corruption is of bigger concern to small firms, as are finance, tax administration, education, and customs. Larger firms find courts, labor regulations, business permits, and electricity more problematic than small firms but the differences are only slight. Crime and disorder seems to be more of an issue for large and very small firms, as compared to medium firms. 47. Unlike size differences, regional differences in the perception of investment climate constraints are significant (Figure 2.18). Electricity is ranked as the top constraint by all provinces apart from Baluchistan which sees corruption as the most important issue, while a third of the other three provinces rank corruption as a top constraint. Macroeconomic stability is considered a top constraint only in Punjab, and to a lesser extent in Sindh. On the other hand, only 15 percent of Punjab firms and 10 percent of firms in NWFP view political instability as a top constraint, while 43 percent of Sindh firms and over half of Baluchistan’s firms consider it so. Crime is not considered a constraint by any firms in NWFP but is so in the other three provinces—particularly Sindh. NWFP is less concerned with economic governance and more with tax rates, customs and trade, finance, land, informal competitors, and courts as the top constraints. Baluchistan’s concern about land availability as a top constraint is also noteworthy. Figure 2.18: Top IC Constraints 100 Punjab Sindh NWFP Baluchistan 75 50 25 0 instability instability Transportation regulations Corruption Finance inistration Custom and Electricity Tax rates Business Land Educated Courts and disorder petitors Crim theft Political workers permits Macro Informal Labor trade s Tax e, com adm Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 48. The investment climate areas which impact productivity and employment are the same according to the econometric analysis and the perceptions of firm managers.25 The investment climate’s association with firm level productivity is primarily through infrastructure, which accounts for more than 30 percent of the IC’s contribution to average log-productivity. 25 With the current econometric methods available, and limitations posed by omitted variables, simultaneity, outliers, missing observations, measurement errors, cluster sampling, selection of the relevant model, etc., results should be treated with caution and inferences of causal relationships between IC variables and outcomes should be avoided. 23 Economic governance, corporate governance and finance, together, account for another half. Not surprisingly, the association of the investment climate with average employment is dominated by labor market issues of skills and wages, but surprisingly not highly affected by productivity (Figure 2.19), possibly reflecting the type of production dominating the sector. Figure 2.19: Percentage Contribution of Investment Climate Groups to Productivity and Employment IC percentage absolute contributions on: Other control variables Average productivity Aggregate productivity Average employment 100% Corporate governance 90% Labor markets and skills 80% Innovation and 70% competition 60% Finance 50% Economic governance 40% Infrastructures 30% 20% Real wages 10% Productivity 0% Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 49. The degree of association of various investment climate areas with aggregate productivity and employment depends very much on the role of the allocative efficiency effect. Results reflect a duality in Pakistan’s economic structure and transmission of investment climate effects In particular, the investment climate’s association coming from infrastructure, economic governance, corporate governance and finance, shrinks for all four of these areas, when comparing average with aggregate productivity. On the other hand there is a much higher role for innovation and labor skills in the aggregate than implied by the association with average productivity. The results show that a larger more formalized firm is associated with the pro- productivity aspects of the investment climate. In other words, the large market share firms are more susceptible to the positive impacts of finance, innovation and skills and less exposed to the negative impact of infrastructure, economic governance and concentrated ownership. 50. The range of specific IC variables which are significantly associated with productivity differences, highlight the wide range of ways the investment climate affects economic growth (Table 2.4). Some variables in infrastructure, economic governance and finance coming from the 2007 estimates remained robust and significant contributors to productivity as compared with 2002. In particular the negative impact of power outages, crime losses, payments to receive government contracts, and the positive impact of access to formal finance were also significant in the 2002 probit model described above. On the other hand, the list of significant variables in 2007 presents some important and revealing differences. In particular, issues relating to government-business interface—for example, number of inspections or time businesses spend complying with regulations—is no longer significant, underscoring the perception among firms that business regulation has improved. 24 Table 2.4: Summary of Impact of Individual IC Variables on Productivity and Employment (Direction of the effect of elasticities and semi-elasticities) Dependent variable Explanatory IC variable Productivity Employment Infrastructures Days to clear customs for exports � interaction with firms that do export � Number of power outages � Dummy for own generator + Electricity from a generator + Dummy for insufficient water supply � Products with own transport + + Shipment losses, exports � Days of inventory of main intermediate material + + Dummy for industrial zone + Economic  Dummy for conflicts with clients with a court involved + governance Dummy for security expenses + + Crime losses � � Payments to obtain a contract with the government � Sales reported to taxes + Dummy for gifts in tax inspections � Finance Purchases paid before delivery � Sales paid after delivery + Working capital financed by internal funds � Working capital financed by private banks + Working capital financed by family/friends � Working capital financed by informal funds � Working capital financed by state�owned banks + Dummy for checking or saving account + + Own land + Dummy for credit line + Dummy for external audit + Innovation &  Dummy for quality certification + competition Dummy for process innovation + New equipment + Computer controlled machinery + Staff with computer + Dummy for e�mail + Dummy for FDI + Exporting experience + Dummy for more than 5 competitors + Labor markets  Staff � production workers + and skills Staff � female workers � + Staff � skilled workers + Dummy for training + Training to non�production workers + Experience of the manager + Education of the manager + Corporate  Largest shareholder � governance Dummy for incorporated comapny + Dummy for limited company + Other control  Trade union + variables Capacity utilization + Dummy for help from BOI + Dummy for help from EPB + Dummy for materials from rural villages with local supplier + Dummy for materials from rural villages with supplier from firm's city � Dummy for materials from rural villages with sub�contractual aarrangement + Productivity + Real wages � Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. Values of the elasticities and semi elasticities and their significance levels are included in the Appendix on econometrics methods. 25 51. Variables which relate to the degree of formality of firms and the ability of formal firms to cope with business problems are highly significant. In infrastructure, these include own generators, own transport, own security, and number of days of inventory. The location in an industrial estate is also significant, representing productivity gains from agglomeration economies. In the case of economic governance variables, there is a strong association between productivity and variables representing a formal nature of firms, including, (i) handling disputes through courts, (ii) reporting sales to tax authorities, (iii) dispersed ownership concentration, and (iv) having checking/savings accounts and access to working capital through private banks. Innovation and skill variables are also significantly associated with productivity differences— including process innovation, new equipment, foreign direct investment, and training. 52. The effect of the individual investment climate (IC) variables are associated with aggregate productivity through average productivity and through the allocation of resources (Figure 2.20). Specifically, 14 percent of the effect IC variables have on aggregate productivity is due to average productivity and the remaining 86 percent due to the allocation effect. The key significant variables and their share in the total average and aggregate productivity, are as follows:  Number of power outages (infrastructure). The share in average productivity is - 13.3 percent and the share in allocative efficiency is 6.7 percent. Hence, the negative effect on productivity is biased towards low market share firms.  Days of inventory of main intermediate material (infrastructure). The share in average productivity is 14 percent, while the allocation effect (9 percent) amplifies the average, indicating the positive effect concentrated in high market share firms.  Sales reported to taxes (economic governance). This variable accounts for 12.8 percent of aggregate productivity and 12.3 percent of average productivity effect.  Working capital financed by internal funds (finance). Out of the total -6.6 percent share in aggregate productivity, -8.3 percent is from average productivity, indicating that the effect is muted and concentrated on the low share of sales firms.  Working capital financed by private banks (finance). The variable is positively associated, accounting for 11.3 percent of productivity. The allocation effect accounts for almost all the effect (9.6 percent) indicating the positive effect is concentrated in firms with high market shares.  Dummy for process innovation (innovation and competition). The share in aggregate productivity is 15.7 percent but like finance, through allocative efficiency (13.1 percent) as the average effect accounts for one sixth of the overall contribution.  Dummy for training (labor markets and skills). Of the total 12.4 percent share in aggregate productivity, 11 percent is from allocation and 1.4 percent due to the average.  Largest shareholders (corporate governance). The aggregate effect is—8.1 percent, muted from—16.2 percent (average) by a positive allocative efficiency of 8.1 percent. 26 Figure 2.20: Investment Climate Contributions on Average and Aggregate Productivity Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. Notes: Percentages are relative to aggregate productivity (IC contributions to aggregate productivity add up to 100). The productivity measure used is the restricted Solow residual in logs (see Appendix on Econometric Methods for details). 53. Through infrastructure and economic governance, evidence shows that larger market share firms seem to cope better with negative aspects of the business climate. In particular, the highly negative association with average productivity is muted on aggregate productivity, as the effect is concentrated on small market share firms. For instance, having a generator is slightly related to improved productivity but the impact is amplified on aggregate productivity as the generators are concentrated in large market share firms. Similarly, the positive association with a firm having a large amount of inventory, using courts and paying for security is also amplified in the aggregate through the allocation effects. 54. In the case of variables reflecting degree of formality, the allocative efficiency effect is small implying that the positive association with formality applies to all firms. Two variables are significant in this regard. First, under economic governance, reporting sales to the tax authorities contributes a large amount to both aggregate and average productivity. Second, the variable of a firm having a bank account is correlated with increased productivity at the average firm. There is a small allocative efficiency term, implying that having a bank account is positively associated with having a large market share. On the other hand there is a strong negative association with having concentrated ownership but, unlike the other two variables, associated with lower market share, muting the negative association in the aggregate. 55. The results strongly indicate that the productivity enhancing variables of finance, innovation and labor skills are associated with larger market share firms. In the case of finance, the negative impact of pre-paying for purchases and financing working capital with internal funds is concentrated on small market share firms while the positive correlation between 27 productivity and working capital financing from private banks is associated with larger market share firms. For innovation and labor skills, the positive association with productivity— especially for new processes and equipment—is concentrated on larger market share firms. The effect is stronger with training variable as a small association with average productivity is amplified in the aggregate. 56. Differences in the relationship between investment climate variables and productivity are relatively robust across provinces and firm size with some small differences with noting. Specifically, infrastructure contributes the highest share to productivity differences in all provinces but its impact is somewhat lower in Baluchistan. On the other hand, the contribution of economic governance to productivity in Baluchistan is higher than it is other provinces. In NWFP, unlike other provinces, the contribution of economic governance, finance and corporate governance to productivity is relatively equal, with the finance and corporate governance contribution being larger than it is in other provinces. The contribution of innovation to productivity is highest in Sindh and lowest in Punjab (Figure 2.21). Figure 2.21: Contribution of Investment Climate Variables to Average Productivity by Province and Firm Size By province 40 Punjab Sindh Baluchistan NWFP 30 Percentage 20 10 0 Infrastucture Economic Finance Innovation Labor markets Corporate Other control governance and and skills governance variables competition By firm size 40 Small firms Medium firms Large firms 30 Percentage 20 10 0 Infrastucture Economic Finance Innovation Labor markets Corporate Other control governance and competition and skills governance variables Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 57. Investment climate variables contributing to employment support the view that aspects of the business environment which reflect formality are significant irrespective of firm type. The largest contributors to employment are the positive contribution of productivity and the negative contribution of real wages. After that, days of inventory, security expenses and having a bank account, contribute significantly—similar to the determinants of productivity. Variables that are significantly associated with employment growth but not productivity include the firm owning 28 land, having external audits and incorporated or limited—all reflecting aspects of formality in the firms. Interestingly, competition in the market, while not as significant a variable for productivity as expected, does play an important contributing role in explaining employment differences (Figure 2.22). Figure 2.22: IC Percentage Contributions on Average Employment Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 58. The statistical relationship between investment climate variables and average labor productivity in the service sector shows some different emphasis from manufacturing.26 As compared with manufacturing, economic governance is more an issue than infrastructure and finance—particularly in those areas which represent government-business interface, such as inspections and manager’s time spent on regulation. As in manufacturing, the negative impact of the investment climate is felt on low market share firms and associated with through variables covering economic governance and finance. In innovation, the firms where labor productivity is associated with staff having a computer are also the ones with a higher market share. Hence the share of finance in average productivity decreases from almost 30 percent to 5 percent, while the share of innovation increases from 7 to over 30 percent in the aggregate. The negative impact of infrastructure on productivity is also amplified for services (Figure 2.23). 26 The approach followed to identify the IC effects on services is somewhat different than in manufacturing, so the results are not directly comparable. While manufacturing focuses on TFP, services focuses on labor productivity. 29 Figure 2.23: Investment Climate Contribution to Labor Productivity in Services Average labor productivity Aggregate labor productivity Finance Finance Economic Economic Innovation and governance competition governance Innovation and competition Infrastructures Infrastructures Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. D. The Way Forward 50. With low investment rates and high labor participation, growth will necessarily come through improved productivity at the firm level, based on a conducive investment climate. The policy analysis which is follows is based on an analytical framework for prioritizing areas of investment climate constraints. In some key areas—such as power, labor, tax, business entry, licensing and financial sector—a considerable number of reforms are ongoing and require deepening, but in others, deep seeded and have been entrenched areas of governance reform require attention to unleash constraints to firm level growth. Such governance issues include rising concerns about corruption, the need to better define and protect property rights, speedier and more certain contract enforcement, better regulation of markets, and the bias in the system against large and formal industrial firms—in terms of tax, energy pricing, credit allocation, etc. 51. The analytical framework underscores the fundamental need for a good macro, trade and competition policy framework and proposes attention to four investment climate areas: As the economy undergoes a strenuous adjustment to past policy conflicts and current market turmoil, the authorities place macroeconomic management and a strong safety net at the top of the policy agenda while maintaining a commitment to an open, competitive trade and foreign investment regime. To sustain these goals over the medium term, a strong investment climate is needed and return to a strong growth path, deeper analysis and policy recommendations are made along the following four areas:  Removal of infrastructure constraints particularly in the energy sector: The power sector’s inadequacies have damaged manufacturing growth with supply constraints reaching a critical point. Unlike other areas where differences across size groups, sectors and geographic areas, there is universal agreement regarding the primacy of the power sector issues as an investment climate constraint. In addition, the notable improvements in telecoms and logistics remain undervalued by an aging and inefficient transport system.  Strengthened governance of market mechanisms: Though improving in recent years, antiquated laws, regulatory compliance and red tape at various levels of government are still problematic, burdensome and costly. More importantly are areas related to corruption in business-government interface, property right protection and contract enforcement, speedier and more certain mechanism for corporate exit and 30 elimination of biases in tax, labor, financial and energy pricing which hinder the incentive to grow and formalize.  Increased depth and improved functioning in labor, land and financial markets. Though firms consider access to these factors less of an issue than other constraints such as electricity or governance, the analysis points to a low level equilibrium in these areas. In the case of labor markets, low skills are only a problem for the few firms which have an educated labor force. In finance, large established firms have access to standard relationship banking, but new entrants are shut out. Risk based or capital market products are non-existent.  Attention to firm level technology adaptation, and the role of public private partnerships (PPPs) in spearheading progress: The low level of technology used by Pakistan firms has at its core both demand and supply side issues. In addition to infrastructure, PPPs should be investigated, as applied to public goods in cluster development, environmental and social standards, technology upgrading and quality assurance. New, risk based financial products are also required to support entrepreneurship and innovation 31 III. PROVIDING BASIC INFRASTRUCTURE FOR COMMERCE A. Introduction. 59. Strong evidence across the globe supports the crucial relationship between infrastructure and economic growth.27 Infrastructure impacts firm level costs and efficiency of production, connects producers and customers, and is relevant to the entire supply chain management. Inadequacies in physical and network infrastructure—such as, power failures, costly and inefficient transport services, insufficient water supply, and delays at ports—create barriers to opportunities, low efficiency levels and impediments to investment. 60. The productivity analysis shows the high association of infrastructure variables with both average and aggregate productivity (Figure 3.1). Frequent power outages are highly significant and negative in their impact on average productivity. The variable accounts for over 13 percent of the investment climate’s contribution to average TFP, but shrinks to around 4 percent in the aggregate since the effect is felt mostly by firms with lower market shares. Conversely, the mitigating variable—having an own independent generator, is positive but accounts for less than 2 percent of the investment climate contribution to average productivity. Since this mitigating measure is concentrated in large market share firms, the contribution rises to more than 4 percent in the aggregate. The other important infrastructure mitigating variable— location in an industrial zone is significant, accounting for 4 percent of the investment climates contribution to average productivity but rising to 4.6 in the aggregate. Finally, the high positive significance of the variable “number of days of inventory� is counter intuitive from the perspective of “just in time production,� but is important as a positive contributor to productivity in a market where delivery risk is high and arms length contracts are unreliable. Figure 3.1: Contribution of Infrastructure Variables to Productivity and Employment By average productivity By aggregate productivity By average employment Number of Number of Dummy for power outages Dummy for own power own generator Days to clear customs generator outages for exports (interaction) Products with Products with own transport Electricity from a TFP own transport generator Days of inventory Wages of main intermediate Dummy for insuficient Days of water supply material Other IC inventory of Dummy for own variables main Other IC Dummy for Other IC transport intermediate variables industrial zone variables material Shipment losses, exports Dummy for Days of inventory industrial zone of main supply Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 61. Access, reliability and cost of electricity, along with improvements in some other areas, is overwhelmingly the most important dimension of Pakistan’s investment climate. Business executives surveyed for the Global Competitiveness Report 2008, ranked Pakistan 83rd among 134 countries for quality of infrastructure—her than other large countries in South Asia but below other key comparators from around the world. However, in terms of electricity supply, 27 The widening infrastructure gap between East Asian and Latin American & Caribbean (LAC) countries accounted for nearly 25 percent of the GDP output gap between these two regions during the 1980-2000 period. (Easterly, 2000). 32 Pakistan ranked much lower, at 120th (Figure 3.2). Domestic firms share this view as electricity is perceived to be a severe problem by 83 percent of them, compared to water supply and transport which 15 percent of firms consider serious, and telecom which is problematic for only 6 percent. Figure 3.2: Perceived Quality of Infrastructure By quality of infrastructure By quality of electricity supply Malaysia Malaysia Chile Thailand Thailand Chile South Africa Egypt China Brazil Egypt China Global mean Global mean Sri Lanka Sri Lanka Turkey Philippines Pakistan Turkey India South Africa Philippines India Vietnam Vietnam Brazil Pakistan Bangladesh Bangladesh 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 Source: Global Competitiveness Index 2008, World Economic Forum. B. Electricity 62. More than 83 percent of Pakistani firms Figure 3.3: Firms Reporting Electricity as a consider power to be a major problem, up from 40 Major or Serious Obstacle to Growth percent in 2002. The perception is practically Pakistan universal across Pakistan, with the view being Bangladesh somewhat less prevalent in NWFP (60 percent) and 2006 Chile Baluchistan (47 percent) than in Sindh and Punjab. 2002 Sri Lanka But, even in NWFP and Baluchistan, the perception has worsened considerably since 2002. Within India manufacturing, the textiles sector is the most Philippines affected and the food sector the least. Turkey Internationally, only Bangladesh compares in terms Egypt of the overwhelming proportion of firms which feel Thailand the power sector is a serious obstacle (Figure 3.3). Brazil Vietnam 63. Pakistan’s electricity consumption is low Malaysia by international standards, but recent demand has South Africa exceeded projections and the trend is likely to hold 0 20 40 60 80 100 over the next few years. The country’s per capita Source: Investment Climate Surveys. electricity consumption (456 kWh in 2005) is high 33 compared to others in South Asia. It ranks as high as India but is low relative to China (1,585 kWh), Thailand (1,988 kWh), Brazil (2,008 kWh), and Malaysia (3,262 kWh). Consumption levels rose by 40 percent from 2002-07, implying a 7 percent per year average growth— significantly higher than the 4 percent growth rate of the 1990s. Pakistan now sells about 73,000 GWh to roughly 19 million customers. Fuelled by economic growth and a strong village electrification drive by the Government, the number of customers rose from about 15 million in 2002/03 to nearly 18.9 million in 2006/07—nearly a million new customers per year with 90 percent of the additions being household consumers. However, electricity consumption by industrial customers, after a decade of near-stagnation, also grew by 7 percent from 2003-06. 64. Pakistan faces a clear energy deficit as planned investments are unlikely to suffice. In contrast with the rapid increase in domestic demand, Pakistan’s power sector is in 28 deficit both in energy and financial terms (Figure 3.4). After years of surplus energy being available in the late 1990s and the early part of this decade, the gap between peak demand and installed capacity has narrowed (Figure 3.5). While it may appear that Pakistan’s nominal installed capacity of almost 20,000 MW in June, 2007, was well above the year’s maximum diversified demand of around 16,000 MW, not all of this capacity was available for generation. There was load-shedding in early 2007, implying that actual capacity at peak demand periods was about 19 percent lower than the installed capacity. An additional 8,000 MW of generation capacity, at a cost of US$ 6.7 billion, is planned by FY 2012. This will take capacity to about 23,500 MW, but peak demand is expected to grow to over 24,000 MW by this year.29 Therefore, even 1600 MW added every year, at a recurring cost of US$ 1.3 billion, may not be sufficient to meet the rising demand. Figure 3.4: Rapid Increase in Domestic Demand Figure 3.5: Demand-Supply Balance: Narrowing Gap Source: Water and Power Development Authority (WAPDA) of Pakistan, and Source: Private Power and Infrastructure Board (PPIB), WAPDA and Karachi World Bank. Electric Supply Company (KESC), Pakistan. Note: Panel A refers to all electricity sold by WAPDA and KESC by consumer category (GWh). Panel B refers to current and projected demand and installed capacity (MW). 28 The demand-suppy equation section draws upon Annex 1 of the Electricity Distribution and Transmission Improvement Project’s Appraisal Document (PAD), World Bank, 2008. 29 Approximately 90 percent of the currently planned capacity additions are in thermal generation. Tight gas supply is a limitation for current gas-fired generation, and gas supply for power generation beyond 2010 is uncertain. Further, imported oil supplies are expected to raise generation costs in a system already dominated by thermal generation. 34 65. Pakistan's energy sources include hydropower, coal, oil and gas, uranium, and alternate energy from sources such as the sun and wind. The current energy mix includes 50 percent natural gas, 30 percent oil, 12.7 percent hydroelectricity, 6.5 percent coal, and 0.8 percent nuclear—similar to that of low income countries but quite different from other South Asian countries which rely more heavily on coal and less on oil and natural gas. The other notable aspect of Pakistan’s energy supply is the high share of hydroelectric sources (Figure 3.6). Figure 3.6: Pakistan’s Energy Mix, 2005 Figure 3.7: Power Sector Prices Electricity production by source type and Losses Across Countries 100% Average sale price of power in South Asia Oil (various years) 80% Nuclear Bhutan Natural gas Bangladesh 60% Pakistan Hydroelectric Nepal ` Coal 40% Srki Lanka 20% Punjab Raj'than 0% Pakistan South Asia Low income High income World Gujarat Source: World Development Indicators. New Delhi 0 6 12 66. Industrial tariffs in Pakistan are in the middle range Source: M. Saqib, Electricity Tariffs in South Asia, draft Note for World Bank Oct, 2009 for the region - lower than Sri Lanka but higher than Bangladesh. Even with the subsidies,30 system losses and Power transmission & distribution losses supply quality problems, electricity tariffs in industrial tariffs in (percent of output - various years) Pakistan end up being at equivalent levels as for India and India Nepal – apart from Delhi, which has a high industrial tariff to Pakistan discourage industrial activity in the capital city. (Figure 3.7) Brazil Tariffs in Bangladesh are due to low generation costs where 80 Egypt percent of power is generated from domestic natural gas.31 Sri Lanka Bhutan has considerable hydroelectric power, thereby Turkey maintaining low generation costs for the domestic users. Vietnam Bangladesh 67. Technical and collection losses impose a severe strain Thailand on the financial sustainability of Pakistan’s power sector. The SouthAfrica country’s electricity system loses more power than all Malaysia comparators, apart from India which lost a quarter of its generated Chile electricity in 2006/07 (Figure 3.7). The losses, caused by 0 10 20 30 Pakistan’s overloaded, under-maintained, and under-invested Source: World Development Indicators, various issues 30 New tariffs have been determined over the years for the eight WAPDA distribution companies, with end-user tariffs being different across the companies. End user tariffs are the same for eight companies and generally lower than tariffs determined by the National Electric Power Regulatory Authority (NEPRA). The difference between the tariffs determined by NEPRA and those notified by the Government will be paid by the Government budget to the power companies as subsidies to consumers. 31 Bangladesh Energy Overview, South Asia Regional Initiative for Energy (SARI/Energy) 35 transmission and distribution systems, cost the country Rs 4.3billion (US$ 68 million) for every one percent lost (in FY2006 losses). There have been some improvements as losses have fallen from a high of 31 percent in 1998/99. From FY1999 to FY2007, transmission losses fell from 7.8 to 6.5 percent and distribution losses fell from 18 to 15 percent in the WAPDA system. The Karachi Electric Supply Company (KESC) system, which was worse to begin with, has also shown some improvement as its transmission and distribution losses have fallen from 46 percent to 34 percent during the same period. In addition to technical losses, the system loses substantial revenues in collection. In FY 2007, the ex-WAPDA distribution companies –now spun off from WAPDA—failed to collect 12 percent of their total billings. 68. Access to power supply is a serious challenge for firms although the pattern differs across location, type and size. Delays in getting electricity connections have become worse for firms and this is a barrier to entry and constraint on expansion. The waiting period for a new connection went up from around 37 to 41 days from 1999-2002. The average waiting period in 2006 deteriorated to 92 days, placing Pakistan among the worst performers in the world, second only to Egypt amongst its comparators. There was also significant variation across states: Baluchistan actually managed to register an improvement in the waiting period (57 to 40 days), while NWFP (52 to168 days) showed deterioration (Figure 3.8). Firms in industrial parks enjoyed a distinct advantage with only 49 days of waiting time compared to other firms that faced 114 days of delay. Similarly, large firms faced a delay of only 27 days while medium-sized firms confronted waiting periods of 136 days. Firms in the chemicals sector received better treatment—about 47 day delays compared with the food sector where firms had to wait for a prohibitive 186 days. With only about 65 percent of Pakistan’s population having access to grid- connected electricity, poor access to power supply has assumed serious dimensions, justifying firm perceptions that electricity is the most important impediment to growth. Figure 3.8: Waiting Days For Electricity Connection International 140 120 100 80 60 40 20 0 South Philippines Malaysia Turkey Vietnam India Thailand Brazil Chile Bangladesh Sri Pakistan Egypt Africa Lanka National 175 FY02 FY07 150 125 100 75 50 25 0 Pakistan Balochistan Punjab Sindh NWFP Small Medium Large Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2002, 2007. 36 69. In addition to technical issues, other Figure 3.9: Informal Payments for Connections factors impede low-cost access to power supply. Pakistan A stunning 84 percent of firms that applied for connections had to make informal payments in Bangladesh order to obtain electricity services—a startling India increase from the 25 percent firms that reported making such payments in 2002 (Figure 3.9). Egypt Certainly, among its comparators, these numbers Vietnam are the worst for Pakistan. In cities like Lahore, Sri Lanka Quetta and Hyderabad, almost every firm applying for a connection is reportedly asked to Turkey make an informal payment. However the system Brazil in is the cleanest with not a single firm in the Philippines sample reporting such a problem. Chile 70. Firms facing unreliable power supply South Africa with frequent outages are disproportionately affected in different regions of Pakistan. Firms 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 face significant interruptions in power supply, Source: Pakistan Investment Climate Survey, 2007. disproportionate to the available generation capacity. Outages are not just pervasive but Figure 3.10: Percent of Firms Experiencing almost universal, with 95 percent of firms Power Outages reporting power outages. Pakistan is at the upper Bangladesh end of the spectrum relative to comparator Pakistan countries, both in terms of the number of hours of Thailand power interruptions in a typical month (78 hours) Egypt and the percentage of firms reporting outages (95 percent). Chile has about half this number of Turkey firms reporting outages and even these firms only Vietnam face an interruption of about three hours (Figure India 3.10). Within Pakistan, the problem varies across Brazil locations—with the city of Hub (21 percent firms South Africa facing 2 hour outages a month) being the best Philippines performer (better than Chile) and Hyderabad (96 percent firms confronting 92 hours of no power Malaysia every month) the worst. The total annual Chile incidence of power outages comes to 945 hours, 0 20 40 60 80 100 comparable to Bangladesh (1105 hours) which is Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. the worst case among the comparator countries in both frequency and number of outages. 71. Power interruptions cause severe financial losses for all Pakistani firms, and affect small firms and the textiles sector the most. Outages, leading to forced downtime, waste of materials, damaged equipment, and added maintenance average 10 percent of annual sales averaged over the entire manufacturing sector. This figure has almost doubled from the reported 6 percent in 2002 and is, again, second only to Bangladesh among comparator countries. The inter-provincial and firm size differences were limited in 2002 but showed greater variation in 37 2006—firms in Sindh now experience double digit losses, while losses in NWFP are in the range of 3 percent. The differences across firm size were also amplified in 2006 with small firms reporting losses almost double those of large firms (Figure 3.11). Figure 3.11: Firms’ Losses Due to Power Outages Internationally Nationally Bangladesh Pakistan Large FY07 Thailand FY02 Egypt Medium Turkey Small Vietnam Sindh India Brazil Punjab South Africa NWFP Philippines Balochistan Malaysia Pakistan Chile 0 20 40 60 80 100 0 5 10 15 Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2002, 2007 72. Though widespread reliance on generators in Pakistan mitigates losses from power outages, the unit cost of power from a generator is much greater than that from the public grid. A fifth of firms own or share a generator, a figure that has halved from the number reported in 2002. The sharp reduction in generator usage is in part a reaction, particular by smaller firms, to increased fuel prices in recent years. For those firms that own power generators, in-house power production represents on an average 6 percent of total consumption. This limited generation seems largely a matter of affordability, since large firms generate 41 percent of their requirements while small firms manage to self-produce only about 3 percent of their requirements (Figure 3.12). About one in every two firms located in industrial parks seems to own a generator and, on an average, self-generates 16 percent of its electricity requirements. This suggests that while access is easier in industrial parks, quality and reliability of supply still remain a formidable challenge. Figure 3.12: Own Generation of Electricity By firms that own or share generators By share of electricity from own generator 80 2002 2006 40 60 30 40 20 20 10 0 0 Baluchistan NWFP Punjab Sindh Pakistan Small Medium Large Pakistan Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2002, 2007. 38 Box 3.1: Power Sector Reforms in Pakistan—A Snapshot The Government strategy for the power sector builds on the wide-ranging institutional, regulatory and structural reforms initiated in the early 1990s which sought to improve the performance and long term sustainability of the sector. As part of the reforms, the Government opened up the sector to private investment, especially in generation, resulting in significant investments by independent power producers (PPs). An independent National Electric Power Regulatory Agency (NEPRA) was created in 1998, and WAPDA was unbundled into a number of generation, transmission and distribution companies. The sector’s deteriorating financial performance in the late 1990s led to some significant improvements in the early 2000s, especially in terms of improved collections of bills. Further reform advances in recent years include: (i) Privatization of KESC in November 2005; (ii) Completion of WAPDA corporate restructuring. In 1998, WAPDA was unbundled into eight distribution companies, a National Transmission and Dispatch Company (NTDC), four thermal generation companies, and a hydropower company. Additional actions taken recently—including transfer of additional high-level officers, division of financial assets and liabilities, and devolution of some major sector services such as construction of secondary transmission grids—have substantially completed the restructuring; (iii) Creation of better conditions for financial recovery of distribution companies. This involved: (a) equity injection by the Government through some debt-for-equity swaps, and (b) determination of company-specific tariffs for all WAPDA successor entities, including distribution companies, accompanied by increases in end- user tariffs (February 2007 and March 2008); (iv) Improvements in technical and commercial efficiency of several distribution companies, especially those operating in Punjab; and (v) Accelerated progress in electrification of villages. Some of the objectives of the 1992 reforms are yet to be fully achieved: (i) Private investment was attracted into the generation sub-sector but after a high in the mid-l990s, there has been a persistent low in recent years (KESC’s privatization has not borne results yet and the Distribution Companies (unbundled from WAPDA) are yet to be privatized); (ii) Quality of service to the end-user has been compromised significantly by power shortages (power riots have been witnessed during peak demand summer months) and by over-loading of the transmission and distribution networks; and (iii) The sector has not achieved financial strength—instead of being a net contributor to the national treasury, it creates a fiscal burden to the tune of $US 1 billion per year. Source: Electricity Distribution and Transmission Improvement Project Appraisal Document, World Bank, 2008. C. Transport and Trade Facilitation 73. Owing to its geo-strategic location, Pakistan is destined to become a trade hub in near future vis-à-vis emerging trans-regional trade links from East to West and from North to South. Among all other means, the road transport is going to play a pivotal access to regional and international markets and the Government is a signatory of many International Agreements on Transport Goods and Passengers. Transit trade agreements with China and a Quadrilateral Agreement with China, Kyrgyzstan and Kazakhstan has already been operationalized transit arrangements with these countries. Agreements with Iran, Turkey, India and Central Asian States like Afghanistan, Tajikistan and Uzbekistan also afford ample opportunities for Pakistan for trade, not only with these countries but also with adjoining countries of the Asia and Europe. Finally, Pakistan is valued by International Forums like ECO, TRACECA and ACD aiming to restore the historic Silk Route by connecting Asia with Europe. 39 74. The efficiency and quality of transport and logistics play a pivotal role in determining firm competitiveness by reducing cost of inputs and moving goods to the market. Road transport is the backbone of Pakistan’s transport system, accounting for 90 percent of national passenger traffic and 96 percent of freight. Over the past decade, road traffic—both passenger and freight—has grown significantly faster than national economic growth. Nearly two-thirds of Pakistan's population lives in rural areas. 75. However, there are a number of challenges to tackle across the entire transport supply chain for Pakistan to capture the potential of good geography and extensive roads. In 2005, GOP launched major initiatives around the National Trade Corridor Improvement Program (NTCIP) to revamp the transport infrastructure trade logistics and services and improve regional connectivity (links with China, Afghanistan /CARs Iran etc.), reduce the cost of trade and transport and bring infrastructure to international standards. The NTCIP also aims to meet increased demand through both improved infrastructure and more efficient services, while keeping costs under control. The framework takes an integrated approach to reduce the cost of doing business in Pakistan and bring the trade and transport logistics chain and services to international standards. 76. While transport does not appear to be a binding constraint for most firms, it is still an issue for the more productive, large, outward-oriented firms. Only 6 percent of firms listed transport among their top three problems, with only 15 percent listing it as a severe obstacle. Access to quality transport services is more an issue for medium and large firms (22 percent) as compared to small firms (14 percent), particularly those located in industrial parks (28 percent). Among the states, Sindh (26 percent) appears to be the most transport-constrained and Baluchistan (7 percent) the least constrained. The metals and machinery sector (23 percent) faces the most serious situation among industrial sectors. 77. Ownership of transport equipment as a mitigating measure to poor access is most prominent in Sindh and NWFP, and particularly by larger firms. Around 11 percent of shipments are transported by firm-owned equipment, with around 17 percent of firms saying that they own transport. A third of firms in Sindh own transport while in Punjab only 6 percent of firms surveyed say they do so. At the same time, around half of large firms own transport equipment which serves about a quarter of their total transport needs. Small firms are able to cover only 10 percent of their needs through own transport (Figure 3.13). Figure 3.13: Firms Owning Transport Equipment and Proportion of Needs Covered Internally By province By firm size % of firms 50 % of firms 25 35 25 % of value % of value 30 40 20 20 25 15 30 15 20 15 10 20 10 10 5 10 5 5 0 0 0 0 Sindh NWFP Baluchistan Punjab Small Medium Large Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 40 78. Losses from mishandling or theft of goods in transit is not a serious problem by international standards but disproportionately affects firms in Sindh and large firms; losses due to spoilage affect SMEs and firms in NWFP. Only 4 percent of Pakistani firms reportedly lost cargo in domestic shipments, amounting to an insignificant 0.3 percent of the value of consignments. About 3.1 percent of exporters in Pakistan report theft-related losses which cause them to lose less than 0.1 percent of their shipment value on average—the figures compare well internationally. However, 16 percent of large firms experience theft as do almost one in ten firms located in Sindh, indicating that the same groups mitigating transport issues through in-sourcing experience a higher incidence of theft in transport (Figure 3.14). Losses due to spoilage or breakage are more pervasive, affecting 16 percent of firms in Pakistan and averaging about 0.3 percent of shipment value—particularly affecting small and medium firms and firms located in NWFP. However, even for these firms, the losses are not too high and average less than 1 percent of their shipment values. Figure 3.14: Transport-related Losses Due to Theft By province By firm size 12.0 0.3 20.0 0.6 % of firms % of firms 10.0 0.2 0.5 % of losses 15.0 % of losses 8.0 0.4 0.2 6.0 10.0 0.3 0.1 4.0 0.2 0.1 5.0 2.0 0.1 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 NWFP Punjab Baluchistan Sindh Small Medium Large Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 79. The strategy for developing transport infrastructure requires a comprehensive approach. Expensive ports, unreliable rail service, slow and expensive road traffic, a stagnant aviation sector, under-developed and costly logistics, and poor rural mobility characterize the transport sector. It suffers from insufficient and badly targeted investments, neglected maintenance, poor management, and inadequately trained labor, all of which impose a cost to the economy of about 4-6 percent of the GDP. The high costs and low reliability of the transport sector constitute a drag on Pakistan's economic growth, reduce the competitiveness of the country's exports, and constrain its ability to integrate into global supply chains that require just-in-time delivery. 32 80. Pakistan needs to construct, maintain and upgrade its rural and urban roads through better governance, funding and oversight. In order to create an efficient, safe, and reliable national highway system, the Government will have to: invest in physical infrastructure; strengthen the institutional, financing and technical capacity of the National Highway Authority (NHA); ensure a stable, secure, and adequate source of funding for road maintenance, and; encourage private sector participation in construction and operation of highway infrastructure. Although the road sector has been the main recipient of public sector funding, consuming about 69 percent of the Public Sector Development Program (PSDP) allocation earmarked for transport and communications, road maintenance expenditures over the years have only been about 20-30 percent of the requirements. 32 World Bank, 2007. 41 81. Trade facilitation goes beyond border taxes; non-tariff barriers play a critical role in reducing costs significantly when goods are moving internationally. Over the last two decades, Pakistan has made several efforts at reducing border taxes. This has led to a significant increase in trade volume. The weighted average applied tariff rate for Pakistan currently equals 16 percent, substantially below the 56 percent rate in 1994. Tariffs on a majority of consumer goods have been reduced to around 25 percent, on most intermediate goods to 10 percent and on raw materials to 5 percent. In part due to these liberalization efforts, Pakistan’s trade to GDP ratio has shown an impressive improvement from 24 percent in the late 1990s to over 30 percent currently. However, an efficient trading system comprises a number of elements and border taxes are only one of them. Efficiency of ports, customs clearance procedures and a transport infrastructure that facilitates the movement of goods between ports and the rest of the country are critical for realizing the potential gains that international trade has to offer. Improving these trade facilitation measures is now beginning to occupy the center stage of trade policy reforms in Pakistan. 82. Efforts to improve trade transport logistics are now the focus of reforms. Apart from quick and easy customs clearance, traders should be able to move their goods at low costs to and from the ports. GOP has launched a major initiative, the National Trade Corridor Improvement Program (NTCIP) to improve the trade and transport logistics chain along the National Trade Corridor (NTC), linking Pakistan’s major ports in the south and south-west with its main industrial centers and neighboring countries. The aim of NTCIP is not restricted to providing a better roads and rail network but also other services (such as various port facilities) required by traders. Box 3.2: Simplifying Customs Procedures in Pakistan Over the last decade, the Government has taken important steps towards simplifying customs procedures. In 1995, Pakistan Revenue Automation Ltd (PRAL) replaced ten documents with one Goods Document (GD) required for customs clearance, and a green channel was established subject to random inspection of 10 percent of goods passing through. Both these measures had a limited scope. The single GD required a number of supporting documents and the green channel covered only about 20 percent of imports. In February 2002, the Federal Bureau of Revenue (FBR) launched the Customs Administrative Reforms (CARE) to further simplify procedures. Based on the FBR’s recommendations, in March 2005, the Pakistan Customs Computerized System (PaCCS) was launched on a pilot basis at Karachi International Container Terminal (KICT). It was extended in 2006 to other port container terminals and the Lahore dry port. PaCCS replaced the former manual clearance system that was characterized by multiple windows, numerous official signatures and verification, and little transparency. In contrast, PaCCS is completely paperless and is a web-based system that allows traders to log in from anywhere in the country to carry out all their customs-related activities. Customs declarations (goods declarations, cargo reporting, vessel information, repayment applications, etc.) are all electronic and available online. Status notifications to traders and carriers are also made electronically. PaCCS is also linked with commercial banks and the central bank (State Bank of Pakistan), whereby the banks can monitor the status of export cargo and regulate the flow of foreign exchange remittances. This link with the banks has considerably reduced paper-work between shippers, commercial banks and Customs. Available evidence shows that the PaCCS has significantly reduced the time between clearance and exit from port, from about seven and a half days to one day or less. 83. Recent reforms have had a positive impact on the trading activities of Pakistani firms. The ICS reveals that it takes 3.7 days on average, after goods arrive at ports, to get customs clearance for exports in Pakistan. The longest time for clearance reported by firms equals 6.1 days (averaged over all firms). Import clearance takes much longer, almost twice on 42 average. The clearance time for exports Figure 3.15: Trade Facilitation Indicators and imports is better than it is for Investment Climate Survey comparator countries and this is a recent Pakistan 2002 Pakistan 2006 Comparators (post-2002) phenomenon, in part due to 30 the string of reforms discussed above 20 (Figure 3.15). There is not much difference in waiting time across small 10 and large firms, but the city of Karachi, being a major port city, performs better 0 Average time Longest time Average time Longest time than the rest of the country. exports exports imports imports 84. Alternative evidence about the Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. business climate in Pakistan tends to Table 3.1: Trading Across Borders: support these trade trends but progress Doing Business Indicators on the next generation of reforms is Pakistan Comparators Pakistan critical to gaining momentum. Doing 2009 2009 2006 Exports: Business provides estimates of the cost, No of documents 9 7 8 time and procedures involved in the Cost (USD) 611 967 966 export and import of goods. Unlike the Time taken (days) 24 19 33 Imports: ICS, the Doing Business Indicators track No of documents 8 8 12 the entire shipment process, starting from Cost (USD) 680 1081 317 Time taken (days) the packaging of goods to their final exit Source: Doing Business, World Bank. 18 21 39 from the port in the case of exports, and for imports, from the time a ship arrives at the port to the shipment’s delivery at the warehouse. The cost of importing and exporting in Pakistan is much lower than it is in comparator countries but the time taken for exports is higher (Figure 3.15). Coupled with the findings from the ICS, the implication here is that factors other than customs clearance, such as port facilities (trade transport logistics), are a more pressing problem in Pakistan relative to other countries. 85. Pakistan will have to persist with the next, more challenging set of reforms to achieve tangible results. Customs delays have reduced since 2002 and efforts must continue to further streamline the process. However, as is evident from the data, it is also necessary to look beyond customs clearance to improving a whole range of trading services, starting with the initiation of export/import contracts and ending with ensuring that goods reach their destinations safely. These reforms may be more difficult and take longer to achieve results than customs automation. Hence, a long term strategy, in close coordination with the NTCIP initiatives, should be followed. D. Water Supply 86. Limited water resources make access to good quality water supply difficult for firms in Pakistan. A good water supply is critical to building a better investment climate and the infrastructure challenge with respect to water is particularly acute in Pakistan. The country relies on the largest contiguous irrigation system in the world, the Indus Basin Irrigation System (IBIS). Per capita water availability in Pakistan is currently 1,100 cubic meters and is projected to decline to 800 cubic meters by the year 2020. Moreover, competition for water is growing among the provinces and across the varied needs for irrigation, industrial and domestic use, and the environment. 43 87. Water supply is the most serious infrastructure constraint Pakistani firms face after electricity, with one in every six firms reporting it as a major or severe obstacle. Water supply is important throughout the supply chain for Pakistan’s main products, whether for cotton in textiles, the feed in dairy, or the standards in fisheries. Given its importance to the production process throughout the value chain, inefficient and unreliable supply of water has a highly adverse impact on a range of micro-level competitiveness drivers. The metals and machinery sector reports being the least affected by water supply, with only 12 percent of firms reporting it as a severe or major obstacle. Due to the nature of its production process the food sector is the most water-constrained, with about one in every three firms citing water supply as a major constraint. The problem of access to reliable water supply appears to lessen with firm size—56 percent of large firms find it a serious constraint but only 12 percent of small firms report it as an issue. Location also plays a central role in determining access to water supply—36 percent of firms in Sindh report themselves to be most severely water-constrained while firms in the water- rich state of Punjab do no share such concerns (Figure 3.16). Figure 3.16: Firms Reporting Water Supply as a Serious Obstacle By province By size of firm 40 60 50 30 40 20 30 20 10 10 0 0 Punjab NWFP Baluchistan Sindh Small Medium Large Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 88. Long waiting periods to obtain water connection do not seem to influence firm perceptions. It is intriguing to find an inverse correlation between firm perception and ease of access to water supply. While large firms feel most severely constrained by water supply, it takes them, on average, only 11 days to obtain new connections. This is in stark contrast to small firms that have to wait for more than a year (416 days) for the same but do not find this a severe obstacle. This suggests that the real issue in water supply is not so much access but quality and reliability of supply. The same pattern is reinforced if we examine firm perception and ease of access by industrial sector. For instance, in the metals and machineries sector, where it takes on average 620 days to get a water connection, firm perception remains the best across sectors vis-à-vis water supply. Similarly, firms in the food sector don’t have to wait more than a mere two weeks, but they find water supply the most constraining among all sectors. Waiting periods vary by location—with firms in Hub, Wazirabad and Quetta waiting less than a week and those in Karachi facing 258 day waits. On this dimension, Pakistan is the worst performer among its comparators with an average wait of 234 days. Even the next worst performer, Egypt, does not have firms waiting for longer than 65 days, while in South Africa the wait is just 4 days (Table 3.2). 89. Corruption is another factor restricting access to water supply but a surprising diversity is reported across the country. While much of the availability of water supply to different regions and sectors is related to technical factors and service policies of distribution systems that cannot be fixed in the short term, corruption is a non-technical factor that severely 44 limits access and can be addressed immediately to enhance the efficiency of the system. To be precise, 62 percent of all firms surveyed (that have applied for new connections) were reportedly asked to make informal payments or gifts in order to obtain water connections. Not a single firm in Chile or South Africa reported such a problem; firms in Pakistan face the most severe corruption on this front relative to its international comparators. Every firm in the chemicals sector that had applied for a connection was asked for such a payment. However, the silver lining is that not a single firm in NWFP or in the sports goods sector reported a request for informal payment. Table 3.2: Quality of and Access to Water Supply in Pakistan: ICS Indicators Waiting period Informal Experienced Average duration Water from to get water payment/bribe insufficient Water shortage of water shortage public sources connection requested water supply incidents (number of (% of water (days) (% of firms) (% of firms) (number) hours) used) Country Pakistan 234 62-3 20-5 5-2 2-5 37-4 Bangladesh 31 41-0 15-7 4-8 0-3 66-7 Chile 41 0-0 4-4 0-0 0-1 86-6 India 24 34-0 7-6 26-8 0-6 22-7 Turkey 7 5-6 16-7 0-4 0-0 45-6 Sri Lanka 19 28-6 35-1 0-0 0-0 - Egypt 65 18-7 - 10-9 3-5 81-7 Brazil 16 2-6 10-0 1-5 1-4 68-4 Philippines - - 25-4 0-0 2-3 52-1 S. Africa 4 0-0 100-0 - 3-4 97-7 State Punjab 107 60-1 8-8 2-2 1-0 26-8 Sindh 258 64-4 39-3 10-3 5-0 51-6 NWFP 18 0-0 12-6 0-3 0-7 65-4 Baluchistan 4 55-8 13-5 1-9 1-9 78-8 Firm size Small 416 49-9 15-5 4-2 1-7 37-8 Medium 20 90-2 54-3 16-4 12-6 33-5 Large 11 66-1 65-5 11-6 5-3 36-5 Source: Pakistan Investment Climate Survey. 90. The unreliability of the water supply in Pakistan further accentuates the problem of difficult access. The three dimensions of a reliable water supply are: proportion of firms affected by disruptions, number of interruptions in a typical month, and average duration of interruptions. These measure the spread, frequency and intensity of the supply problem. According to this definition, Pakistan is one of the worst performers, along with South Africa where firms report a worse situation, among comparator countries. In Pakistan, 21 percent of the surveyed firms experienced service interruptions five times a month on an average. The average interruption lasted two and a half hours. A lesser proportion of small firms (16 percent) were affected relative to large firms (66 percent). No firm in Sialkot or Sheikhpura reported a service interruption while 43 percent of firms in Karachi complained of supply disruptions. Location in industrial parks does not ensure better water supply—firms in these parks (45 percent of firms, 11 times a month and 6 hours) report poorer quality supply compared to others (11 percent, thrice a month and one hour). 45 91. The Government needs a sustainable and long-term strategy to address the maintenance and development of Pakistan’s water assets. Federal and provincial authorities should develop a culture and practice of asset rehabilitation and management. Pakistan is endowed with a large water resources infrastructure, most of which is owned and managed by the provinces and is quite old. Due to the precarious condition of the canals, pipes and treatment plants, the infrastructure does not produce the services it should and people have to adapt to unreliable and sub-standard services. The asset management plans must make explicit the requirements (and trade-offs) for public and user financing. It is also important to develop efficient institutional arrangements for rehabilitating and maintaining infrastructure. 92. The investment climate in the water sector is severely constrained relative to current and future levels of demand. The returns to investment in the water sector (irrigation, hydropower, domestic and industrial uses, and environment) are very high in Pakistan. However, the lag in investments is becoming a major constraining factor in developing a vibrant water sector. Many of the multipurpose reservoirs, though primarily constructed to meet water demands for irrigation, actually recover their costs from the sale of hydropower. There has to be a shift in the financing strategy for multipurpose storage. So far, the Government has only tapped public resources for investments in water and hydropower systems and currently owns the major assets in the sector. Hydropower generation provides substantial financial flows and could be of great interest to the private sector if the operations are structured properly. The extent of the investment demands may require nontraditional methods for financing infrastructure, such as involving the domestic and foreign private sectors, the securitization and privatization of existing assets, and building public-private partnerships. E. Telecommunications 93. Telecommunications is the least-constraining infrastructure obstacle for firms. Improving access to information communication infrastructure (ICI) spurs economic growth and is an important component of a better investment climate. Studies have shown the correlation between the increase in tele-density and an overall increase in productivity. It is estimated that a 10 percent increase in tele-density results in GDP growth of 0.6 percent. There is also evidence that the marginal productivity of investments in telecommunications infrastructure is higher than similar investments in roads and electricity. The performance of the telecom sector in Pakistan has been the most encouraging among all the components of infrastructure. 94. Accordingly, firm perception has improved from 2002, when 9 percent of firms found telecommunications to be a major or severe obstacle to growth, to about 6 percent of firms in 2006. From 2002-2006, Punjab was the front-runner, with the percentage of firms reporting telecommunications as a major constraint falling from 10 to 1. Likewise, this constraint has eased most for large firms (15 percent to 3 percent) in these four years (Figure 3.17). In terms of sectors, textiles reported the most (12 percent) and metals and machinery the least (3 percent) number of firms severely constrained by telecommunications. However, relative to its international comparators, Pakistan (6 percent) did not fare so well, except in comparison to India where about 8 percent of firms reported this constraint as binding. 46 Figure 3.17: Firms Reporting Telecommunications as a Serious Obstacle Internationally Nationally 15 10 13 8 11 6 9 7 4 5 2 3 1 0 -1 Brazil Bangla S.Lanka Chile Turkey Egypt Pakistan India Punjab Baluchistan NWFP Sindh Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 95. The performance of the telecommunications sector has improved in recent years. Penetration levels have increased due to the regulatory reforms introduced by the Pakistan Telecommunications Authority (PTA) to increase competition. The progressive deregulation policy of 2003 liberalized the local loop (LL), long distance and international (LDI) markets and was followed by the 2004 Mobile Cellular Policy which opened competition in the cellular market through liberalizing and access to foreign investors. This market opening coupled with the 2004 landmark decision to privatize the fixed line monopoly—Pakistan Telecommunication Company Limited (PTCL) have made the market extremely competitive and driven down tariff rates to among the lowest in the world.33 The result was a surge in foreign direct investment into the sector, reaching a third in FY07-08, and a huge spike in mobile phone subscriptions rapidly outstripping the main line subscriptions. (Figure 3.18).34 Figure 3.18: FDI in Telecommunications and Mobile/Fixed Density 70.00 6,000 60.00 5,000 Mobile Density Telecom FDI 50.00 Total Fixed Density 4,000 Non�Telecome FDI 40.00 3,000 30.00 2,000 20.00 1,000 10.00 0 0.00 FY02 FY03 FY04 FY05 FY06 FY07 FY08 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 Source: Pakistan Telecommunications Authority 96. Despite the impressive expansion of the telecommunications market over the past decade, there is remains considerable room for rapid growth. Pakistan’s telecommunications market is the third fastest growing in Asia after China and India, (and fastest in South Asia if 33 Average Revenue per User (ARPU) is estimated to be below US $5 which is amongst the lowest in the world netting them the lowest average revenues per user in the world and sparking a race to find value-added services (like mobile phone-based branchless banking) to boost revenues. 34 Average Revenue per User (ARPU) is estimated to be below US $5 which is amongst the lowest in the world netting them the lowest average revenues per user in the world and sparking a race to find value-added services (like mobile phone-based branchless banking) to boost revenues. 47 considering growth in teledensity35). The sector has Figure 3.19: International Comparisons of attracted foreign investment of US$ 4 billion in Total Teledensity FY07-08 over the past two years (Figure 3.18). In 100 Bangladesh particular, recent mobile subscriber growth has been 90 Brazil impressive, with close to 2 million new subscribers 80 70 Chile Egypt, Arab Rep. per month. While Pakistan has the highest mobile 60 India penetration in South Asia, at 49 percent (and access 50 Malaysia Pakistan 40 by 91 percent of the population)36, it can go further to 30 South Africa reach the levels of Malaysia and South Africa 20 Sri Lanka Thailand 10 penetration of almost 90 percent. (Figure 3.19). In 0 Turkey contrast to the dynamic mobile phone market, the 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 Vietnam fixed-line segment has been relatively modest, with an increase from 4 to 5.2 million from 2003 to 2007. Source: Pakistan Economic Survey, 2007/08. 97. Lack of basic infrastructure and low literacy rates limits the use of internet and broadband services in Pakistan. The ICS results emphasize that cost of software, unavailability of internet connection, lack of skilled workers, and quality of internet services severely constrain the level and growth of internet usage. Another important reason cited by firms for low internet usage is that clients and suppliers do not use internet. Pakistan has virtually insignificant broadband penetration, the lowest among its comparators (Figure 3.20). In addition, the literacy rate is also one of the major factors which constraints the level and growth of internet usage. Figure 3.20: Firms Reporting Telecommunications as a Serious Obstacle Mobile phone penetration Broad band penetration South Africa Chile Malaysia Turkey Chile Malaysia Turkey Thailand Brazil Brazil Vietnam Pakistan Thailand Sri Lanka Egypt Egypt Vietnam Sri Lanka Bangladesh India India Pakistan 0 20 40 60 80 100 0 2 4 6 8 Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 98. Internet use is low by international standards but there is wide variation across regions and sectors. With only a quarter of all firms using the internet, Pakistan is significantly behind Chile (94 percent) and Turkey (73 percent), among others. However, not surprisingly, trading firms register a near complete internet penetration (94 percent) (Figure 3.21). Location in industrial estates facilitates better internet access and 58 percent of firms located in these zones use it. Internet usage also depends on location with firms in Hub reporting 100 percent usage while firms in Quetta and Sheikhpura report the lowest usage levels. Larger firm size appears to increase the 35 Pakistan Telecommunication Authority 36 Ibid 48 probability of web use, which is consistent with the positive relationship between returns on web use and a firm’s client-base. As access to telecommunications services is one of the determinants of web-diffusion, one can conjecture that relatively poorer telecommunication services in Baluchistan may be affecting web-diffusion in that state (10 percent). Figure 3.21: Proportion of Firms Using Either Email or Website. Internationally Nationally Chile Large Turkey Medium Sri Lanka Small India Sindh Bangladesh NWFP Philippines Punjab Egypt Baluchistan Pakistan 0 20 40 60 80 100 0 50 100 150 Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 99. Waiting periods for obtaining new telephone connections have gone down from 2002 but the trend is driven by only two states—Sindh and NWFP. The number of days to obtain a new connection has improved from 47 days in 2002 to 41 days in 2006. However, this hides important regional variations. Over this period, the situation has significantly worsened in Punjab (54 to 75 days) and Baluchistan (47 to 116 days), but considerably improved in Sindh (32 to 14 days) and NWFP (49 to 16 days). Pakistan is among the bottom rung of comparators, with India where it now takes 11 days to get a new connection, Turkey (9 days) and South Africa (8 days) setting the standards for quick and easy access. Across cities and industrial sectors, likewise, there is a high level of variation (Figure 3.22).37 Figure 3.22: Waiting Period for Telephone Connection Internationally Nationally Egypt Large Bangladesh Medium Sri Lanka Pakistan Small Brazil Balochistan Chile Philippines Punjab India NWFP Turkey S. Africa Sindh 0 50 100 150 0 50 100 150 Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 37 The Ministry for Information and Technology reports that the waiting period for obtaining a new telephone connection from the largest fixed line service provider, PTCL is seven day – considerably less that that being reported by the firms. 49 100. The incidence of informal payments or gifts to Figure 3.23: Informal Payment for obtain telephone connections has almost doubled since Telephone Connection 2002; it represents one of the few negative developments in Bangladesh the sector. The percentage of firms that face requests for Pakistan bribes or speed money to obtain new telephone connections Egypt has increased from 19 in 2002 to 34 in 2006, highlighting a India marked increase in corruption. Compared internationally, Turkey Pakistan is second only to Bangladesh (71 percent) in terms Philippines of corruption in this sector, in sharp contrast to Chile and South Africa where firms report virtually no corruption of Sri Lanka this kind (Figure 3.23). Firm size also matters in this respect Brazil in Pakistan, possibly due to the lack of leverage for small S. Africa firms, 37 percent of which face the problem compared to Chile only 9 percent of large firms. Firms in Sindh registered a 45 0 20 40 60 80 percent spread in corruption, on the other end of the Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. spectrum from Baluchistan where no firms reported informal payment requests. Among industrial sectors, the chemicals sector appears to be hardest hit (79 percent of firms) and the food sector the least (6 percent of firms). Lahore (69 percent) is the worst performer while Wazirabad, Faislabad, Sheikhpura and Hub report zero incidence of the phenomenon. 101. Telecommunications access and use in village and small town enterprises (part of the recent rural investment climate study) is surprisingly limited, considering that about 60 percent enterprises are engaged in trade. Approximately 28 percent of responding small-town entrepreneurs owned fixed line phones and 9 percent owned cellular phones. The comparable figures for village entrepreneurs were 7 percent and 4 percent, respectively. Overall, small-town entrepreneurs in NWFP appeared to have slightly better connectivity than their counterparts in other states. PICS 2006 found that only 26 percent of urban firms in Pakistan regularly use the internet to communicate with customers or suppliers—far less than firms in China (71 percent), India (62 percent) and Bangladesh (50 percent). Access and connectivity to the internet for rural and small-town firms is extremely limited; only one percent of the latter reported using email. Lack of adequate infrastructure and transportation makes it considerably more expensive for the rural population to travel to urban markets to access services. The difficulty of integrating rural markets into the formal economy is often cited as a contributing factor to the higher poverty rate in rural areas. It is equally more costly for telecom service providers, public and private, to reach the rural markets due to lack of appropriate infrastructure. 102. The Government in partnership with the Pakistan Telecommunication Authority and private companies, are attempting to aggressively address the digital divide. The Ministry of Information Technology, (MoIT) created Universal Service Fund (USF) Company in 2007 with an independent Public-Private Board of Directors with the objective to spread the benefits of the telecom revolution to all corners of Pakistan. Since May 2007, USF has started Rural Telecom services projects in 7 different areas (called “Lots�), for which contracts have been signed with the major telecom service providers in the country. The main aim of the program is to bring focus to rural population to all customers requesting service in the areas covered through the support of the USF at published national tariffs. The second program being followed is Broadband for Un-served Urban Areas which has been launched to improve broadband penetration in the un-served urban areas. This program will also give boost to provision of other e-services like e-health, e-government, e-commerce etc. 50 F. The Way Forward 103. Notable progress has been made in the power sector recently. The regulator of tariffs has issued notifications specific to each distribution company, setting the stage for increased financial autonomy for these entities and proper functioning of the wholesale market—designed to start as a single-buyer model with subsequent transition to more liberalized trading arrangements. To improve sector governance, the Government has separated the chairmanships of the Pakistan Electric Power Company (PEPCO) and WAPDA. It has placed public-sector thermal generation companies, as well as the transmission and distribution companies, under PEPCO. Public-sector hydroelectric generation companies will be under WAPDA. To support private participation in infrastructure, the Government has developed a comprehensive and robust framework for PPPs. It has also created the Infrastructure Project Development Facility (IPDF) to help bridge infrastructure gaps over the next 5-10 years. 104. Higher rates of investment are needed to generate additional electricity, relieve power shortages and prevent load-shedding. The sheer magnitude of the required investment requires private participation for at least two thirds of the additional capacity38 and at least 3-4 years to achieve improvements in the quantity and quality of power supply. In addition, as 60 percent of planned generation plants will rely on gas and imported oil, securing additional gas supplies for current and future gas-fired generation plants is a priority. 105. On the demand side, power efficiency can by encouraged through price and non- price means. Specifically, the Government should: (i) pursue a pricing strategy which reduces subsidization in favor of cost-reflective tariffs, more aggressive time-of-use metering, and a tariff structure that discourages consumption during peak load hours; (ii) encourage more efficient end-use equipment (lighting, refrigeration, air-conditioning, industrial motors and processes, etc.); and (iii) have vigorous awareness campaigns among consumers to increase efficiency. 106. The power sector needs to achieve financial sustainability to enable better maintenance and future expansions. Specifically: (i) tariffs received must reflect the cost of operating, maintaining, and expanding the system,39 (ii) A deadline needs to be established for the Government to make regulatory decisions legally binding. This can help avoid situations where the Government can effectively veto regulatory decisions simply by not notifying them, (iii) the regulatory lag of some six months between changes in fuel prices and NEPRA’s tariff adjustment, as well as the period for the Government’s notification, needs to be shortened; (iv) if uniform tariff is applied nationwide timely payments must be made to cover the difference between determined and notified tariffs; and (v) there has to be a substantial reduction in technical (transmission and distribution) and commercial (collection) losses which currently stand at a quarter of net generation due to overloaded, under-invested, and under-maintained networks.40 38 The average Government investment per year is planned at US $2 billion. The balance of US $4 billion per year needs to be raised through international development agencies and the private sector. 39 The Government has adjusted electricity prices only twice since late 2003–in February 2007 and March 2008– by about 9-10 percent each time. But the revenue impact was less than 7 percent due to exemptions and differentiated increases. The notification of 31 percent in September 2008 was suspended in the next month. 40 In 2006-07, a 1 percent reduction in technical losses would have yielded US$ 68 million in additional revenue. 51 107. The tariff structure needs to be rationalized to create a level playing field. The prevailing tariff structure is distorted and results in suboptimal consumption patterns, undermining the financial sustainability of the power sector and discouraging industrial activity.41 The tariff structure needs to be improved to better target subsidies, reduce cross- subsidies, and make administration of electricity bills easier and less prone to abuse. 108. In the long run, diversifying the energy mix should be an important element of the power sector strategy Natural gas reserves are expected to start declining after 2010, therefore Pakistan will have to focus on diversifying energy production to include more hydropower, clean coal, nuclear, and renewable (wind, solar and other alternatives) energy sources, with a target of raising non fossil energy by one fifth today to one third by 2030. Such an overall strategy must be wide reaching, encompassing all forms of energy as various sources of energy are required for different purposes—e.g. transportation, household cooking, and power generation. 109. The NTCIP, as the medium-term policy framework for the transport sector, has recorded early gains, but progress is needed to address the main recipients of public support.42 Policies have been developed to: (i) modernize and streamline trade and transport logistics; (ii) improve port efficiency; (iii) create a commercial and accountable environment in Pakistan Railways; (iv) modernize the trucking industry; (v) sustain delivery of an efficient, safe and reliable national highway system; and (vi) ensure safe, secure, economical, and efficient civil aviation operations and boost air trade. Specifically, progress is needed to (i) restructure and possibly corporatize public sector enterprises involved in transport, (ii) establish a sustainable financing program and improve the governance structure for the NHA (iii) pursue PPPs, particularly in highways, (iv) invest in strategic highway links (i.e. with Gawadar, Karachi, etc) and (v) scale up the successes of the customs pilot programs as an urgent, straightforward and achievable goal moving to a post clearance audit (PCA) regime.43 110. In the water sector, the Government needs a sustainable and long-term strategy to address maintenance and development of assets. The large water resources infrastructure— including canals, pipes and treatment plants—is old and provides unreliable and sub-standard services. Governments, at the provincial level need to begin rehabilitation of irrigation system in the short-term and expand and improve the infrastructure for water through investment in dams, storage reservoirs and canals in the medium term. For waste, governments can install pilot plants for solid waste consumptions in the short term and invest in collecting and treating urban and industrial waste.44 Then following investments, federal and provincial authorities should manage assets in a way that makes explicit the requirements (and trade-offs) for public versus user financing, and make efficient use and implementation of that public’s trust. 41 Rates discriminate by customer type (domestic, commercial, industrial, and agricultural) and amount of usage (tariffs increase sharply with usage), with industrial consumers subsidizing residential and agricultural consumers. 42 Gains include reductions in port entry charges by 15 percent, port transit time from 9 to 4 days, customs clearance time from 4 to 1 day for containers. The one daily freight express trains increased to 5. 43 Based on a pilot approach to a paperless environment, customs clearance time came down, advance lodging of manifests eliminated pre-customs delays, and interface between customs officials and importers was reduced. 44 The City District Government Lahore is already planning a mega integrated solid waste management project in PPP mode, whereas a consultancy to develop a master plan for Lahore SWM system is also being planned. A solid waste management project is also being planned in Faisalabad with the help of IPDF 52 111. In telecommunications, the regulatory framework and telecom policy need to keep pace with the fast-changing dynamics of market evolution. The fast growing and highly competitive sector is producing innovations in applications and business models which challenge the Government’s regulatory and policy-making capacity. There is a need for continuous development of policy and regulatory frameworks to meet the needs of the market, including approaches to increasing broadband penetration, shared infrastructure licensing, convergence policies, and other ICT related issues. In addition to these emerging issues, Pakistan’s Frequency Allocation Board should upgrade the spectrum management system to make it effective in managing growing competition and the introduction of new wireless technologies and services such as 3G and 4G. 112. The private sector’s involvement in provision of infrastructure services is sporadic and far behind the neighboring countries. Pakistan has had significant success in attracting private investments in the telecommunications sector in the 1980s and the power sector in the 1990s aims to deepen that success while broadening to other infrastructure areas such as transport & logistics, water supply, effluent treatment, and irrigation. Progress to date, includes a legal framework for PPP, the establishment of the Infrastructure Projects Development Facility (IPDF) and the recent adoption of a PPP policy. The next steps, on the public side, would be a more specific institutional, set up with clarity on public management at the IPDF and related agencies, of the (i) deal making process, (ii) legal and operational risks and (iii) financial obligations and contingencies. The provincial governments, specifically the Government of Punjab is also working toward developing comprehensive PPP framework, and plans model transactions in power, waste management, toll roads, and others. On the private side, the mobilizing of domestic resources to invest in such new PPP type of vehicles will be create major demands for financial sector deepening and corporate sector transparency. 53 IV. STRENGTHENING GOVERNANCE THROUGH BETTER REGULATION A. The Business Environment and Competitiveness 113. Fair and predictable business rules, entry to and contestability of markets, orderly and speedy exit for firms, and low compliance cost of regulations are critical for fostering a good business environment. The smooth operation of the institutional factors behind market governance is particularly important but, in Pakistan, these factors are often a greater obstacle to firms than the legislated aspects of business regulation. Such factors—relating to instability, corruption, and ineffective rule of law (more specifically insecure property rights)—weaken the forces behind efficiency, investment and innovation and impinge on the ability of firms to take risks and appropriate returns. Time and resources spent on overcoming these factors divert firms from more productive activities, undermining the growth of the private sector. With respect to business regulations, high and uncertain entry, operation and exit costs create market frictions and blunt the efficient allocation of resources within the economy. Such regulations also prevent the culling of inefficient and low-productive units, hinder firm level growth, and stymie resources from going to new ventures. 114. Institutional and regulatory factors affecting the economic governance of markets are important determinants of productivity; these factors account for 20-30 percent of the IC’s contribution to productivity. Economic governance variables account for around 30 percent of the investment climate’s contribution to average productivity, and a little less than 20 percent of IC contribution to aggregate productivity (Figure 4.1). The reason for the difference are the important variables related to deeper institutional factors and strongly associated with less formal firms that command a smaller share of the market. For example, the governance variables most strongly associated with productivity differences are: (i) sales reported to taxes, (ii) gifts to tax inspectors, (iii) payments to obtain government contracts, and (iv) losses associated with crime. These variables play a more important role in average productivity (almost 15 percent) than in aggregate productivity (around 9 percent). Conversely, using courts to resolve conflicts is more important for aggregate productivity (3.8 percent) than average productivity (1.5 percent), due to the stronger role played by this variable in the business of larger market share firms. Figure 4.1: Contribution of Economic Governance Variables to Productivity and Employment By average productivity By aggregate productivity By average employment Dummy for Dummy for Dummy for conflicts security Dummy for conflicts security Crime losses with clients with a court expenses with clients with a expenses involved Crime losses court involved Payments to Payments to obtain a contract with obtain a contract with the government the government TFP Sales reported to taxes Sales reported Wages to taxes Dummy for gifts Other IC variables Dummy for gifts in tax inspections in tax inspections Other IC variables Other IC variables Dummy for security expenses Crime losses Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 115. Pakistan has performed better than international comparators in reducing the compliance costs of regulation but is lagging in improvements in deeper institutional factors. 54 Although Pakistan has achieved a less burdensome regulatory environment by international standards, it is lagging in the performance of deeper institutional factors such as protection of private property rights, corruption, quality of judiciary, and law and order situation. This is evidenced by several sources and also revealed by examining Pakistan’s performance relative to comparator countries (average values) along four dimensions of the regulatory environment and four dimensions of institutional factors (Figure 4.2). In particular, the Worldwide Governance Indicators (WGI) of the World Bank for Pakistan show weak scores and little progress over time, apart from in the year 2003 when the country performed slightly better in controlling corruption, maintaining rule of law and governing effectively. Since then the indicators apart from ‘regulatory quality’ and ‘voice and accountability’, have deteriorated. Figure 4.2: Business Climate By regulatory factors By deeper institutional factors 15 Comparators Pakistan 20 Comparators Pakistan Percentage of firms Percentage of firms 15 10 10 5 5 0 0 Ease of Business Time spent on Top marginal Property Enforcing Corruption Quality of regulation freedom index regulations tax rate rights index contracts perception legal structure index index Sources: Doing Business (Ease of Regulation, Enforcing Contracts), Investment Climate Surveys (Time spent on regulations) , Heritage Foundation (Business Freedom Index, Property Rights Index) Frazier Institute (Top Tax Rate, Quality of Legal Structure), and Transparency International (Corruption Perception Index) . 116. Firm level perceptions corroborate the observation that institutional factors rather than regulatory factors are the primary obstacles in the investment climate. On average, more than one in three firms perceives each of the deeper institutional factors as a serious obstacle; only one in five firms considers the regulatory factors to be major obstacles (Figure 4.3). With the exception of tax rates, a similar picture emerges when regulatory and deeper institutional factors are compared individually. One reason for this could be that firms are particularly sensitive to tax rates and therefore likely to complain more about them relative to other problems. Even in the comparator countries, complaints about high tax rates are more widespread than for any of the other obstacles. Figure 4.3: Major Or Very Severe Obstacles To Doing Business By regulatory factors By deeper institutional factors 50 Comparators Pakistan 60 Comparators Pakistan Percentage of firms Percentage of firms 40 50 40 30 30 20 20 10 10 0 0 Tax rates Tax Obtaining Informality Anti- Functioning of Crime, theft and Corruption administration licenses competitive courts disorder practices Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 55 117. Efforts towards lowering regulatory hurdles for business have had a positive impact on firm productivity and enterprise perceptions of the investment climate. As described in Chapter 1, firms rank business regulation low on the list of investment climate obstacles. This is supported by empirical evidence but issues still remain (Figure 4.4). The regulatory environment in Pakistan, broadly defined to include licensing requirements, labor inspections, entry and exit procedures for firms, and tax rates and tax administration, compares well with the same in other developing countries. In the 2010 Doing Business rankings, Pakistan ranked 85th in the world in the composite index of ten indicators, at around the same as its 2009 ranking but better than many comparator countries and best in South Asia, apart from the Maldives. Within the rankings, Pakistan is positioned relatively low with respect to regulations supporting taxation, licensing and property registration, but its ranking on starting and closing a business (enforcing security) is better. Figure 4.4: Global Rankings in Doing Business, 2009/2010 By country 2010 2009 140 120 100 80 60 40 20 0 South Africa Chile Turkey Pakistan Sri Lanka Egypt Bangladesh Brazil India Philippines Nationally, by type of regulation 160 2010 2009 140 120 100 80 60 40 20 0 Closing A Starting A Getting Registering Paying Taxes Enforcing Business Business Permits Property Contracts Source: Doing Business, 2010. B. Taxation 118. Firms in Pakistan complain about high taxes but their concerns have decreased from previous years. Tax rates always rank high in firms’ perceptions as an obstacle in the investment climate and Pakistani firms are not different. Close to 40 percent of Pakistani firms find tax rates an obstacle to their business, slightly lower than the average of 43 percent in comparator countries (Figure 4.5). The figure, however, is a marked improvement from 2002 when 47 percent Pakistani firms considered tax rates a major problem. Recent analysis by the World Bank and others shows that in accordance with international trends, the corporate income tax rates on 56 private companies have dropped from over 55 percent in the 1990s to a uniform 35 percent, apart from a more favorable rate for small companies. Figure 4.5: Tax Rates as Major or very Severe Obstacle By year By firm size 120 Percentage firms 100 100 Percen tag e firms 80 80 60 60 40 40 20 20 0 0 Manufacturing Manufacturing Large Medium Small 2002 2006 By international comparison 100 80 60 40 20 0 Brazil Turkey Egypt Pakistan India PhilippinesBangladesh Sri South Chile Lanka Africa Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 119. However, despite the recent improvements in tax rates, there is significant room for further gains. While complaints against taxes are not unusual, in Pakistan there is some objective evidence that the complaints have some relevance for policy makers. According to Doing Business,45 Pakistan ranks 143 out of 183 countries in the with respect to the paying taxes indicator, falling from 126 in 2009. A number of problems have been identified in a recent analysis by the World Bank.46 First, average and marginal tax rates vary greatly by sector and are relatively high, with the bulk of the burden falling on large formal manufacturing firms. Industry accounts for 23 percent of GDP but pays half of all federal taxes. In addition, many activities are ‘zero rated’ in the General Sales Tax (GST), based on policy and other considerations, such as activities which are perceived to support export orientation. Some of these points are explored in greater detail below based on the Investment Climate Survey. 120. Application of the tax code includes many exemptions which distort the effective tax incidence. In 2008 the impact was dramatic. Despite the introduction of the two higher rates of GST earlier in the year, the total tax rate—including exemptions and incentives―went from 42.2 and 40.7 in 2006 and 2007 respectively, to 28.9 and 31.6 in 2008 and 2009 respectively, making Pakistan’s total tax rate one of the lowest among comparator countries (Figure 4.6). Such wide variance in effective tax rates across activities and sectors leads to decisions about resource allocation, location, investment, etc., to be based on tax considerations rather than underlying economic reasons. 45 In the DB methodology, three indicators are constructed: (i) number of tax payments, which takes into account method and frequency of payment and the number of agencies involved, (ii) time in terms of number of hours per year necessary to prepare, file and pay taxes, and (iii) total tax rate measuring amount and mandatory contributions. 46 The World Bank, Tax Policy Reform in Pakistan, 2009. 57 Figure 4.6: Effective Total Tax Rate, 2009 70 60 50 40 30 20 10 0 Chile South Africa Pakistan Bangladesh Vietnam Egypt Turkey Philippines Sri Lanka China India Brazil Source: Doing Business, 2010. 121. Reforms in tax administration have been implemented and have improved the situation nationwide. In 2002, the Government initiated a comprehensive institutional and procedural reform of tax administration to improve effectiveness, responsiveness and efficiency. The program has had significant impact on firm perceptions. Now, only a quarter of firms consider tax administration a major obstacle in their business, compared with almost half of all firms in 2002. Nationally, 40 percent of large firms consider tax administration a major obstacle, as do half of the firms in NWFP (Figure 4.7). Figure 4.7: Percent of Firms Considering Tax Administration as A Major Obstacle Internationally Nationally 100 ICS various years Pakistan 2002 60 80 50 40 60 30 40 20 20 10 0 0 Brazil Turkey Egypt Bangladesh India Philippines Pakistan Sri Lanka S. Africa Chile Large Medium Small NWFP Sindh Punjab Balochistan Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2002 & 2007. 122. The specific tax reforms have been comprehensive and multi-faceted, targeting outreach, automation, simplification, and improved compliance. Some of the specific reforms undertaken at the Federal Board of Revenue (FBR) include: (i) taxpayer education and facilitation, (ii) better customer service to facilitate discharge of taxpayer obligation—through upgraded infrastructure and the setting up of three large and medium taxpayer units (LTUs) and thirteen Regional Tax Offices (RTOs) in big cities, (iii) introduction of universal self assessment scheme, (iv) co-location of income tax and sales tax, (v) automation through mandatory electronic filing of sales tax returns by corporate clients, electronic filing of tax returns and automated sales tax refunds; (vi) institutional reform (restructuring FBR along functional lines) and human resource development; (vii) improved compliance through strengthened audit capacity; and (viii) implementation of an integrity strategy and (ix) minimizing contact between FBR officials and taxpayers,(x) introduction of internal audit and internal affairs, and (xi) frequent taxpayer feedback surveys. 123. Though the self-assessment scheme has yet to take off beyond large firms, its overall effect on firm perception has been dramatic. The share of firms that perceived tax administration 58 as a serious obstacle to business halved Figure 4.8: Percent of Firms Using FBR between 2002 and 2007. This share is also Self-assessment Regime now lower for Pakistan than most 30 comparator countries, with only Sri Lanka 25 performing better in terms of its regional 20 neighbors. Provincially, NWFP witnessed the least improvement while across firm-size 15 the perception among small and medium 10 firms has improved the most. However, the 5 use of the self-assessment scheme for tax 0 payments is still low nationally―at 7 MaufacturingKarachi Lahore Hyderabad Other Large Industrial percent; it is virtually absent outside the big cities firms parks cities and large firms (Figure 4.8). Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. C. Entry, Exit and Anti-Competitive Behavior 124. Pakistan is one of a few of the comparator countries to reduce its time and cost for business registration this year. The reduction in time and cost is the first since business registration was streamlined in the early part of the decade Through process engineering and more recently, an electronic registration platform, businesses can now submit registration forms and company reports Figure 4.9: DB Ranking for Starting a Business (required under the law) electronically. As a result, the Doing Business indicator is now at 20 days to register a India business in Pakistan — down from 24 and a cost of 5.8 Philippines percent of per capita income — down from 13 percent. The Chile relative improvements caused Pakistan’s ranking to jump an Brazil impressive 17 places to 63 from 80. (Figure 4.9) In the Vietnam comparator countries, the average cost is much higher, at 21 Bangladesh percent, and the time taken is twice as much, on average. In Pakistan, the maximum time for a start-up is taken up by China 2009 2010 registration for sales tax (12 days), with the employee social South Africa security institution (11 days) and the Employees Old-Age Pakistan Benefits Institution (EOBI).47 These are important potential Turkey areas for reform. For example, in Egypt, where the start-up Sri Lanka time has declined sharply from 37 days (in 2004) to 7 days Egypt (currently), increased automation in the tax registration process enables the process to take only one to two days 0 25 50 75 100 125 150 175 compared with 12 in Pakistan. Source: Doing Business 2010, 2009 125. However, the time and cost required to secure land, utility connections and construction licenses is a considerable barrier to entry. As discussed in Chapters II and VI, as well as section D below, these processes—many of which are governed at the provincial and local level, have not improved but have instead deteriorated over the period, in some cases significantly. For example, according to the ICS, the time for utility connections is high and requires unofficial payments. Local processes, covering registrations, taxations, inspections, etc, are currently being reviewed 47 These procedures are pursued simultaneously. 59 through a Doing Business type of methodology to find areas which may be streamlined and improved. Competition, learning and public private partnerships will be sought to as methods for implementing process oriented reforms at the provincial and local levels. 126. The Doing Business “Closing a Business� indicator is favorable for Pakistan through the use of extra-ordinary banking powers rather than corporate legislation.48 The indicator shows an impressive performance by Pakistan in keeping the cost low at 4 percent of the claim. The average is 16 percent for comparator countries and 8 percent for OECD countries. Pakistan shows a high recovery rate of 40 cents on a dollar and a relatively short time period of less than three years to execute the transaction. (Figure 4.10). In fact, according to Doing Business, Pakistan ranks 53rd in the world in this indicator - the country’s second highest ranking out of the ten indicators. In practice, the situation is somewhat more complex as the true insolvency process follows a different route – one which is pursued through corporate law and the Companies Ordinance, 1984 rather than banking law and the Financial Recovery Ordinance. Figure 4.10: Cost and Time to Execute Lien on Immovable Property in an Insolvency By cost and recovery rate By time Pakistan India Sri Lanka Philippines Bangladesh Vietnam Recovery India Cost Chile Brazil Egypt Vietnam Banglade… Turkey Brazil Chile Turkey South Africa Pakistan Egypt South… China Sri Lanka Philippines China 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 0 2 4 6 8 Source: 2009 Doing Business database. 127. The authorities embarked on a comprehensive review to modernize the corporate law regime, starting with rehabilitation under conditions of corporate insolvency. A Corporate Law Review Commission (CLRC) was established by the SECP in 2006 to undertake a comprehensive review of the Company’s Ordinance, 1984, including particular, modernization of the corporate insolvency and liquidation regime. This is still in process and is likely to take some time. In the interim, considering the lack of formal rehabilitation / restructuring possibility under the existing legal framework for company entering the insolvency process. Therefore a committee, led by the SECP was mandated to fast track the finalization and enactment of the draft Corporate Rehabilitation Act (CRA) 48 The Doing Business indicator case represents part of the story of closing a business, at least for Pakistan. The case cited refers more to a proceeding under the Financial Recovery Ordinance which seeks to execute claims on already pledged property (as opposed to an insolvency involving all creditors, assets and liabilities). The Ordinance was extraordinary legislation in the late 1990s which sought to reverse the crises of non-payment of that time. 60 with the features of a “Chapter 11� type of work out arrangement. Such a framework will require (i) a delicate treatment in the law of the debtor-creditor balance, (ii) integration with existing legislation49, and (iii) a program of capacity building for an the new professionals and incumbents - from the receivers through to the accreditation boards to the judiciary — for new systems to be absorbed and applied. It is necessary to modern corporate rules and oversight in general and particularly in the area of rehabilitation and liquidation of financial and non-financial firms. 128. The new Competition Law and Policy regime brought into force in 2007 is fully operational with a fully independent and active Commission and a limited staff and staffing. Efforts by the newly formed Competition Commission of Pakistan (CCP) to create a better culture of competition though law enforcement and non-law enforcement means have taken hold. Important cases have been pursued in traditional and non-traditional sectors which have had impact both in themselves and creating more governance compliant firm behavior. At the same time, a strong advocacy campaign has raised the profile of competition in all areas of the economy, including those nascent and growing network industries regulated by other sector regulators. Internationally, the CCP has been recognized by the OECD Competition Committee honorary Observer Status in 2009-10, has chaired working groups and committee meetings at the OECD, International Competition Network (ICN), and bi-lateral agencies aground the world. It has also been written up as a “good governance� organization in the recent Transparency International country report for Pakistan.50 129. With the end of the first Chairmanship’s tenure, the Government will be faced with a important decision for its succession, in terms of the direction the CCP will take. Now that the regime has been implementable and effective, strengthening the institutional structure will be the Government’s next priority. Though all rules were notified to strengthened the CCP’s independences in funding and conditions for the commissioners, they have not yet been implemented fully. The Government also needs to pursue capacity building support for the institution in order to building professional skills, particularly in the area of economic analysis in support of decision making, to accompany its high level of legal capacities. The CCP has developed programs to this end and has been able carry out a limited number of on-site activities and limited overseas training. but a shortage of resources and the security situation in the country has constrained its efforts thus far. D. Licensing and Permits 130. By international standards, Pakistan has low burden of Figure 4.11: Licenses as Serious licenses and permits on the business operations of its firms, but Obstacle: Firm Size there is a wide variation among cities and provinces. About 17 20 percent of the firms in Pakistan complained of difficulty in 15 obtaining licenses and permits, compared to 14 percent in 10 comparator countries. This burden is less in industrial parks as 5 the waiting time for an operating license is less than seven days 0 Large Medium Small compared with the national average of 30 days. The average Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. waiting time in comparator countries is 46 days. Licenses were also perceived to be a greater obstacle for smaller Pakistani firms (Figure 4.11). 49 Key existing and proposed legislation includes, the Companies Ordinance, Amendments to the Banking Companies Ordinance, the new State Bank of Pakistan Act, the Proposed SECP act, the Employment and Service Conditions Act (or its precedent), the Competition Ordinance, the Financial Recovery Ordinance and others. 50 Reference to Pakistan in Transparency International. 61 131. Provinces can learn from each other in the areas of business regulation (permits and licenses are a sub-national matter) where there are important regional variations. Large variations exist not only in the perception of licensing as a constraint, but in the procedures, time and costs across cities. This is in large part due to differences in the national, provincial and municipal level regulatory requirements, as well as the quality of local government bodies (Figure 4.12). A survey of six Pakistani cities in 2007 revealed significant regional variations in the processes covered by the Doing Business Indicators. For example, starting a business is easiest in Peshawar while resolving a commercial dispute through a court is easiest in Karachi. Figure 4.12: Obtaining Licenses and Permits as A Serious Obstacle Internationally Nationally Islamabad South Wazirabad Africa Sheikhupura Chile Gujranwala Sri Lanka Faisalabad India Quetta Bangladesh Hyderabad Hub Philippines Karachi Pakistan Lahore Egypt Sialkot Brazil Peshawar Turkey Sukkur 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007 132. Licensing for site development and land registration are generally local governance issues and there are significant differences in procedures, time and costs across cities (Table 4.1). For example, a fewer number of licensing procedures in Karachi does not necessarily mean a better licensing regime. Karachi takes more time for the completion of common steps and lacks three licensing steps, compared with Punjab and NWFP, which are related to environmental protection: (i) an environmental protection inspection, (ii) a no-objection from the Environmental Protection Agency, and (iii) an electricity inspection. It takes much longer in Karachi to get electricity and water connections. On the other hand, Karachi requires two tax-related steps: (i) copies of tax valuation, and (ii) an inspection from the Tax and Excise Department. On the other hand Peshawar’s lower time requirements result from doing common processes faster.51 51 At the pre-completion stage, Punjab cities require almost 80 days for approvals and inspections as compared to Peshawar’s 47 days. For environmental inspections, Faisalabad and Sialkot require 54 days as opposed to 46 in Peshawar. And for utility connections, Lahore and Sialkot require 110 and 115 days as compared with 80 days in Peshawar. At post construction, the final approvals for occupancy, inspections and completion of certificates account for over 38 days in Lahore, as compared with 12 days in Peshawar. 62 Table 4.1: Dealing with Licenses Time Requirements for Common and Non Common Steps Karachi Peshawar Lahore Faisalabad Sialkot Pre-Approvals and Inspection 106 47 79 77 78 Letter Regarding Land Title 30 15 15 30 15 Building Permit/Approval of Site Plan 60 30 60 45 60 City Inspections During Construction 16 2 4 2 3 Utilities 180 80 110 80 115 Electricity Connection 75 35 45 35 45 Telephone Connection 45 35 45 35 45 Water and Sewage 60 10 20 10 25 Post Construction 52 12 38 32 31 Apply for Occupancy and Inspection 30 10 30 30 23 City Final Inspection 15 1 1 1 1 Receipt of Completion Certificate 7 1 7 1 7 Non-Common Steps 31 49 39 57 57 No Objection Certificate for Environment na 45 35 53 53 Environment Inspection na 1 1 1 1 Electricity Inspection na 3 3 3 3 Tax Valuation and Copy from E&T dept 30 na na na na Inspection from Tax Department 1 na na na na 133. An analysis of local policies and procedures for land registration reveals how cities and provinces can learn from each other to lower cost and time requirements (Table 4.2 and Table 4.3). Karachi is the easiest city in which to register property, followed by Lahore, Sialkot and Faisalabad. Karachi requires a relatively small number of procedures for land registration while cities in Punjab have more procedures/steps but lower time and cost requirements. Of the 15 different possible process steps, Karachi uses 6, Quetta 12, and cities in Punjab 7- 9. Mutating the title with the revenue office and entering the deed at the Excise and Taxation department are required in all cities except Karachi, adding 21-25 days to registration time. The capital value tax and transfer tax required in Punjab are not necessary in Karachi or Peshawar. Even certain registration steps that are common to all provinces, such as ‘registering the deed’, differ in their time requirements across cities, ranging from 3 days in Faisalabad to 8 days in Lahore to 13 days in Sialkot. Cities in Punjab register land at a lower cost than other cities in Pakistan, particularly Peshawar and Quetta. Table 4.2: Registration of Property Cost Lahore Faisalabad Sialkot Karachi Peshawar Quetta Duties and fees* 1,385 1,385 1,384 1,380 1,901 2,762 Deed Preparation 33 17 33 84 3 17 Other fee** 1 1 1 50 8 25 Total 1,419 1,403 1,418 1,514 1,912 2,804 * Stamp duty, registration, transfer tax, mutation fees. ** Advertising, no demand excerpt, land tax excerpt, affidavit from seller, non encumbrance certificate. 63 Table 4.3: Registering Property Time (days) Lahore Faisalabad Sialkot Karachi Peshawar Quetta Obtain a non-encumbrance certificate 3 3 4 3 23 Payment of stamp duty and registration fees 3 3 3 31 1 3 Deed writer prepares deed 2 1 1 1 2 2 Register deed at registry 8 3 13 38 8 23 Mutate title at revenue officer 3 5 3 3 15 Enter deed at Excise and Taxation department 20 20 18 25 10 Pay capital value tax 1 1 1 Pay transfer tax 1 1 1 1 Apply for stamp paper 1 Receipt of payment is taken to Stamp Office 1 Advertisement in newspaper 8 8 Obtain No Demand certificate 2 2 Obtain land tax excerpt 2 2 Assess capital gains tax 3 Prepare affidavit for seller 1 Total 41 38 43 49 47 93 * Some of the steps can take concurrently, so the number of days shown as total may differ from the total time required to register property. E. Governance and Corruption Figure 4.13: Consistent and Predictable Interpretation of Rules 134. Consistent interpretation and By firms size and province By international comparison application of rules and regulations is an Balochistan Brazil important reflection of good governance. Pakistan Sindh Discretion or lack of predictability and Philippines consistency in the interpretation of rules and Punjab Turkey regulations (by Government officials) is NWFP indeed a severe problem in Pakistan (Figure S. Africa 4.13). Only 46 percent of firms in Pakistan Small India believe that officials interpret rules Medium Sri Lanka consistently, compared with 60 percent in Chile comparator countries (Figure 4.13). The view Large Average that the Government interprets rules 0 20 40 60 80 100 0 20 40 60 80 100 consistently is shared more by large firms than Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. small and medium ones, an important observation reflecting the productivity analysis in Chapter I. National differences reveal the provincial role in good governance. Only one in five firms in Baluchistan believes that the implementation of rules by Government officials is consistent and predictable, while three-quarters of firms in NWFP believe so. 135. Corruption, a serious and growing obstacle to the investment climate, is largely associated with business-government interface. Corruption is considered a severe constraint by more than half of all firms (57 percent) in Pakistan, significantly higher than the 40 percent figure from 2002 and much higher than for comparator countries, with the exception of Brazil and Bangladesh (Figure 4.14). It is common for firms in Pakistan to pay informal payments to 64 Government officials to get things done. In 2006, three out of every four firms strongly agreed or tended to agree with the preceding statement. Overall, almost half of all Pakistani firms reported at least one incident of bribe due to the listed sources.52 A higher share of large firms reported bribe incidence and a third more firms (than the average) in Sindh cited instances of bribe. 136. Results show that perceptions about corruption in Pakistan are based on actual experiences with paying bribes. In other words, the probability that a firm reported corruption as a serious obstacle rises by 29 percentage points (against a mean of 57 percent in the full sample) if the firm experienced at least one incident of bribe. This relationship is statistically significant at less than 5 percent level and robust to a number of controls such as firm-size, location and sector. Hence, it is not surprising that the pattern of bribe payments discussed in detail below is roughly similar to what we found above for firm- perceptions on corruption. As with perceptions of corruption, bribe incidence in Pakistan has increased 20 percent over time—from 40 percent in 2002 to 48 percent in 2007. Figure 4.14: Interface with Government and Corruption By corruption as a serious obstacle By incidence of bribes by type and location of firm Brazil Small Bangladesh Pakistan Medium Turkey Large Egypt Punjab Philippines NWFP India Chile Balochistan Sri Lanka Sindh South Africa 0 20 40 60 80 100 Percentage of firms 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 137. The amount of bribe paid in Pakistan is difficult to estimate but available evidence suggests it is not too high by international standards, although it varies by region. Firms were asked the amount of bribe that firms in their industries pay to Government officials to get things done. The bribe rate (as a percentage of annual sales) in Pakistan equals 0.7 percent on average, compared with 1 percent in comparator countries. Across states, Sindh and Baluchistan lie at the two extremes. Firms in Islamabad (including Rawalpindi) reported the highest bribe rate of 2.7 percent, followed by firms in Karachi (1.4 percent), and Lahore where the figure was less than 0.1 percent. The findings suggest that relative to other countries, bribery in Pakistan is more widespread (affects a larger proportion of firms), but the bribe rate is lower although not by a significant amount. 52 Bribe incidence rates shown equal the percentage of firms in the full sample (or the listed sample) that report at least one incident of bribe due to tax and labor inspections, obtaining a utility connection (electricity, telephone, water), obtaining a permit (operating, construction or import license), obtaining Government benefits (customs duty drawback, profit tax exemption, sales tax refund and export rebate), or obtaining land titles. 65 138. The types of inspections involving most corruption are labor and tax inspections, respectively. About 29 percent of all Pakistani firms reported instances of bribes due to labor inspections and 27 percent due to tax inspections. These inspections covered 48 and 50 percent of the firms in the full sample, respectively. More importantly, the incidence of reporting corruption was almost double among firms which were inspected by tax or labor officials. Two-thirds of firms inspected by tax or labor inspectors reported corruption, as compared with one-third of non- inspected firms. Similarly, three out of every four firms that applied for utility connections or permits (licenses), reported corruption to be a serious obstacle. The numbers were the same for firms that received Government benefits (Figure 4.15). These findings indicate precisely where corruption is most burdensome and point to target areas for corruption-related reforms. Figure 4.15: Relationship Between Inspections and Bribes By tax inspections By labor inspection Brazil South Africa South Africa Inspections Sri Lanka Sri Lanka Incidence of bribe Inspections Chile Turkey Conditional Incidence of bribe Turkey incidence of bribe Brazil Conditional incidence of bribe Egypt Philippines Philippines Egypt Bangladesh Bangladesh India India Pakistan Pakistan 0 20 40 60 80 100 0 20 40 60 80 100 Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 139. Compared to other countries, Pakistan has a high overall incidence of bribe due to tax and labor inspections—despite having a smaller percentage of firms that are inspected. Compared to other countries, the ‘conditional incidence of a bribe’ is highest in Pakistan. This means that for each inspection, the likelihood that a firm in Pakistan will be requested or was requested to pay a bribe is higher than it is in any of the comparator countries.53 In contrast, firms in Egypt have almost twice as many inspections but much less incidence of bribes. These findings are consistent with the conclusions that curtailing corruption in Pakistan requires not only a reduction in the interaction between Government functionaries and the private firms, but also greater checks and balances on Government officials as well. 140. Inspections raise the probability of corruption in other countries but translates less into firms’ perception that corruption is a problem, implying better interaction with government. In 53 Conditional incidence of bribe is calculated for the set of firms receiving tax and labor inspections. The figure shown is of the percentage which paid a bribe out of all firms that were inspected by tax or labor inspectors. 66 the comparator countries the incidence of Figure 4.16: Interface with Government and corruption is about the same, regardless of whether Corruption a firm is inspected or not, but is somewhat higher By inspected firms and recipients of gov. benefits if a firm is receiving government benefits. In Percentage of firms 100 Pakistan Comparators Pakistan, however, the 57 percent incidence of 80 corruption among manufacturing firms rises to 68 60 percent if the firms are inspected and 72 percent if 40 the firms are receiving Government benefits 20 (Figure 4.16). At the same time, being located in 0 industrial zones raises the perception of corruption Inspected (by tax and Not inspected Receiving (by tax, labor govt. benefits – but more acutely in Pakistan than other labor dept.) dept.) countries. Almost 75 percent of firms in Pakistan’s industrial zones and 55 percent of firms in the By industrial estates and total manufacturing industrial zones of comparator countries consider 70 Pakistan Comparators corruption to be a serious problem, compared with Percentage of firms 60 50 percent internationally. One plausible 50 explanation for this could be that firms in 40 industrial zones in Pakistan are more visible and 30 hence make easier targets. 20 10 0 141. While the Government of Pakistan has Industrial zone Manufacturing taken steps to tackle corruption, much remains to Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007 . be accomplished. In an attempt to decrease corruption by reducing the interaction between tax officials and private agents, the Government raised the threshold for GST registration from Rs. 0.5 million to Rs. 5 million, freeing 42,000 previously registered GST taxpayers from corruption-related problems. However, this solution came at the cost of decreased tax revenue. A much less costly, and arguably more effective, effort was made by the Federal Bureau of Revenue (FBR) towards improving the integrity and accountability of its inspectors. A recent task force report noted losses in tax revenue due to corruption (by tax officials), and an urgent need to curb these losses. It recommended minimal contact between tax payees and tax officials, end-to-end automation of tax filing and refunds, better recruitment policies to weed out potentially corrupt officials, simplified tax structures, minimal discretion to tax officials in determining tax liabilities, etc. 142. Further reform efforts to curb tax-related corruption were launched recently. The FBR is currently preparing to launch a comprehensive integrity program to: cover, inter alia, operational systems, human resource policies, internal audit policies and processes; identify indicators to measure progress; develop effective internal audit policies and processes; and properly document cases that can be subsequently defended in the courts so that proper penalties can be applied. To this end, an Integrity Management Steering Committee (IMSC) has been set up to study the entire issue of integrity of the tax and revenue departments. In late 2005, the Directorate General of Intelligence & Integrity (I&I) was assigned the additional task of vigilance against corrupt practices by FBR staff. 67 F. Crime and Security Figure 4.17: Crime and Security Crime is a 143. Crime, but more so security, is a serious serious and growing issue in Pakistan’s obstacle investment climate. In FY07, a third of Experienced losses due Pakistan Pakistani firms perceived crime and security as to theft Comparators a serious obstacle, compared with a quarter of Spend on firms in comparator countries (Figure 4.17). seecurity Only Brazil had a higher share of firms that considered crime a serious issue. Relative to 0 20 40 Percentage of firms 60 other countries, crime and security losses are Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. less widespread in Pakistan but more intense. A smaller percentage of firms are affected by Figure 4.18: Crime Losses & Security Expenses crime and security-related expenses in Pakistan 3 compared with other countries. However, Losses due to Crime Security Expenses among the affected firms, losses are higher in 2 Pakistan than elsewhere. Consequently, the burden of crime and security, averaged over all 1 firms, is roughly the same between Pakistan and the comparator countries. 0 Balochistan Punjab Sindh NWFP 144. Expenses on security and losses due to Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. crime, averaged over all firms, show a significant variation across firm-size and regions (Figure 4.18). Over 97 percent of large and medium Pakistani firms spend on security, compared with 40 percent of small firms. However, average expenditure per firm is roughly the same (around 1 percent of annual sales) for both groups. State-wise, close to 77 percent of firms in NWFP reported spending on security, with average expenses equaling 1.3 percent of annual sales. In contrast, only 35 percent of firms in Baluchistan spent on security but their expenses averaged a high of 2.2 percent. Industrial parks showed better performance with much lower theft losses than firms in the rest of the country. 145. Concerns about security and risk-mitigating expenses appeared to outstrip the actual reported incidents of crime by firms. Even though only 10 percent of firms reported experiencing incidents of crime (theft, robbery, vandalism, or arson), almost half of them spent money on security Moreover, expenses on security far exceeded losses due to crime. Three observations are important in this respect. First, in Pakistan, official reporting of crime is far less prevalent than the incidents of crime themselves. Second, the potential threat of crime can exacerbate both security expenses and the intensity of the perception that (potential) crime is an obstacle. Third, the threat of security-related incidents in Pakistan, as opposed to other comparator countries, is by itself a growing problem that is joining and possibly surpassing crime as a concern for firms. G. The Functioning of Courts 146. The functioning of the judiciary is a serious obstacle for over a third of Pakistani firms, compared with approximately a fifth of firms in comparator countries. The perception in Pakistan that the court system is an obstacle is actually higher than it is among other 68 comparators, apart from Turkey where 41 percent of Figure 4.19: Courts as a Serious Obstacle firms consider courts a major problem. An efficient Punjab court system is important to protect investments by firms and ensure that disputes between private agents, or NWFP between the government and private agents, are resolved without hindering business activity. This is especially so Balochistan for the more formalized sectors where long-term Sindh investments are necessary (for example, the chemicals sector) and, by the same logic, particularly for larger Small firms. At the sub-national level, it is not surprising that Medium almost two-thirds of firms in Sindh consider courts to be a serious obstacle to the investment climate. But the Large finding that only a quarter of firms in Punjab believe this 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 to be so, compared to half the firms in NWFP and Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. Baluchistan, indicates either a better functioning system in the state, or less need for courts, or that Punjab firms use a more informal system of dispute resolution and contract enforcement (Figure 4.19). 147. Poor perception about the quality of the courts system translates into usage; most firms rarely use the courts to settle disputes. While use of a third party to settle a dispute is generally low to begin with (only 5 percent of Pakistani firms do so) (Figure 4.20), the number represents a 70 percent decrease from four years ago. It is also a sixth of the number of firms that use third parties to settle disputes in Chile and only slightly higher than that of firms in Bangladesh (4 percent), the only two comparator countries for which data is available. When third parties are used by Pakistani firms, only a few of the firms involved use the courts system—slightly less than a third (31 percent) of the 5 percent of firms. In contrast, the corresponding figure is as high as 70 percent in Chile and 65 percent in Bangladesh (Figure 4.20). Figure 4.20: Use of Courts for Disputes: Internationally By use of a third party to resolve disputes By use of courts to solve disputes 35 % firms 30 100 30 25 80 70 65 20 16 60 15 40 30 31 10 5 4 20 5 0 0 Manuf act Manufact Bangladesh Chile M anufact M anufact B angladesh Chile (2002) (2006) (2002) (2006) Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007 and World Bank Enterprise Surveys. 148. Court usage is much higher among relatively large Pakistani firms (Figure 4.21). Over three-quarters of large firms use courts when seeking third party intervention. Less than half of the firms of all sizes in Sindh do so, followed by Punjab where only a quarter of the firms use courts. Strikingly, in the city of Hub, about 63 percent of firms (not shown) used third party intervention but not a single one among these used the court system. 69 Figure 4.21: Use of Courts for Disputes: Nationally By use of a third party to resolve disputes By use of courts to solve disputes NWFP NWFP Balochistan Balochistan Sindh Punjab Punjab Sindh Small Small Medium Medium Large Large 0 5 10 15 20 25 0 20 40 60 80 100 Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007 and World Bank Enterprise Surveys. 149. By international standards, courts in Pakistan are faster at arriving at judgments but the enforcement of these decisions takes much longer. In our sample, a court decision was reached in 47 percent of the cases (firms) that went to court. The majority of these cases were in the cities of Karachi and Lahore. Compared with over 43 weeks in Bangladesh and 60 weeks in Chile, it takes 29 weeks in Pakistan to reach a decision (Figure 4.22). In contrast, enforcement of the decision takes 23 weeks in Pakistan but only 8 in Bangladesh and less than 14 in Chile. These findings suggest that while reforms at reducing court time are important, deeper institutional reforms for a more effective and timely enforcement of laws are perhaps more important. Figure 4.22: Quality of the Courts By time taken to reach a decision and enforce By perceptions about the quality of courts, percent of firms 60 National average Comparators Decision Enforcement 60 50 50 40 40 30 30 20 20 10 10 0 0 Pakistan Chile Bangladesh Quick Affordable Impartial Able to enforce decisions Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007 and World Bank Enterprise Surveys. 150. Pakistani firms perceive the quality of their courts system far more negatively than firms in other countries. Consistent with the findings above, firm-perceptions about court speed are reasonably good relative to the average among comparator countries (Bangladesh, Chile, Brazil), though much lower than Bangladesh’s 16 percent. However, in impartiality and affordability of courts and especially in the enforcement of court decisions, Pakistan lags far behind (Figure 4.23). Within Pakistan, with respect to the objective measures discussed above, perceptions about the quality of courts are typically better among firms located in industrial parks and among relatively larger firms. 70 Figure 4.23: Public-Private Dialogue By size By province By sector 60 30 40 40 20 30 20 20 10 10 0 0 0 Large Medium Small Punjab Balochistan Sindh NWFP Textiles, Sports goods Food Metal & Chemicals Garments Machinery & Leather Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007 and World Bank Enterprise Surveys. H Public-Private Dialogue 151. Creating a good investment climate requires more than the removal of immediate constraints. It calls for a transformation in the relationship between business and government, to build confidence that improving the business environment will remain a central objective of future policy making. One-off regulatory reforms such as improvements in business registration, though beneficial in themselves, rarely have a long-lasting impact on the confidence of the private sector to invest in a country. Successful regulatory reform is therefore not just about cutting the immediate red tape (that is, tackling the ‘symptoms’) but about making a good investment climate an on-going objective in future policy making. This can be enhanced by public-private cooperation. 152. The ICS provides some information on the extent of private-public dialogue in Pakistan. While 22 percent of all manufacturing firms are involved in policy discussions with the Government, much of this discussion is restricted to firms in the textiles and sports goods sectors (together 55 percent) and the relatively large firms (52 percent) (Figure 4.24). Interestingly, the relatively larger and richer cities, such as Lahore and Karachi, show lower participation than some of the other smaller cities. Not surprisingly, Punjab province leads the way with over a quarter of the firms saying they have had a dialogue with the Government. Only half this number (13 percent) of firms from NWFP reported doing so. These differences suggest considerable scope for improvement in the lagging cities and sectors. Figure 4.24: Agency Outreach By time By size of firm By province 20 SMEDA EPB BOI 60 SMEDA EPB BOI 30 SMEDA EPB BOI 50 25 15 40 20 10 30 15 20 10 5 10 5 0 0 0 Large Medium Small Balochistan NWFP Sindh Punjab 2006 2002 Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. I. Informality 153. Badly designed and administered regulations impose major constraints to growth and productivity and create strong incentives for small businesses to remain in the informal economy. 71 Difficulty in obtaining licenses and permits to start or expand a business tends to prevent entry of new firms, reducing the level of competition and, therefore, firm efficiency. Informality refers to competition from the informal sector, that is, from competitors who manage to partially or totally avoid compliance with formal rules and regulations (for example, on taxation, labor, health and safety, etc.). These informal firms thus obtain an unfair competitive advantage over firms which comply with the full sets of rules and regulations. Informality tends to hurt businesses in the formal sector of small and medium size firms, as well as industries with low levels of initial sunk investment. 154. The workforce reported for tax purposes shows some variation across countries and within Pakistan. At the national level, firms report about 75 percent of their workforce for tax purposes, one of the lowest with respect to comparable countries. The range of variation in the reported level of workforce within Pakistan (Figure 4.25) reveals significant variations across regions, with the states of Sindh and NWFP performing much better than the rest of the country. Also, as expected, larger firms and those located in industrial parks (92 percent) report higher levels of their workforce than their respective counterparts—68 percent for firms outside industrial parks (not shown). Figure 4.25: Percent of Workforce Reported for Tax Purposes By international comparison By province 100 100 80 80 60 60 40 40 20 20 0 0 Bangladesh Chile Egypt India Pakistan Turkey NWFP Sindh Punjab Balochistan Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 155. Despite an estimated large informal sector in the country, few firms in the ICS considered informality a serious problem. In Pakistan, the informal sector could be as large as 35-40 percent of the official economy. However, only 17 percent of firms surveyed considered it a serious problem. The findings for Pakistan are also counter-intuitive with regard to firm size and sectors, that is, while large firms suffer more than small firms from informality, the problem is much more severe for the medium firms (Figure 4.26). Normally, small firms compete much more intensely with the informal sector. Also, in Pakistan, sectors with high entry costs, such as chemicals, are more affected by informality than others (food, textiles) where entry costs are likely to be much lower (3.26). These results suggest that the conventional understanding of informality, at least in the context of a country like Pakistan, may not be of much help in understanding the consequences of informality. More careful research in this area is therefore necessary. Figure 4.26: Percent of Firms That Say Informality is a Serious Obstacle By state By firm By sectors 30 30 Percentage of firms 25 30 25 25 20 20 20 15 15 15 10 10 10 5 5 5 0 0 0 Medium Small Large Chemicals Food Metal & Textiles, Sports Balochistan NWFP Sindh Punjab Machinery Garments goods & Leather Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 72 J. The Way Forward 156. Establishing a sound regulatory system, underpinned by non-distorting product market policies, will in time positively influence informal behaviors. Informal norms that determine implementation and enforcement of formal rules and regulations continuously interact. In a process of ‘adaptive expectations,’ the evolution of informal norms is continuously affected by changes in existing rules.54 This implies that Pakistan’s adoption of a formal regulatory framework that is typical of higher income countries, may be instrumental in accelerating the adaptation of informal norms to the formal rules 157. Progress in the area of business regulation has had demonstrated effects on the perceptions and efficiency of the business community. However, the analysis shows that for the private sector to provide the engine of growth and thus underpin and sustain efforts toward macroeconomic stability, the policy framework needs to deepen regulatory reforms. This means increasing competition and fluidity and lowering the cost of doing business for all sectors. Four areas are of particular importance: tax administration and policy, business licensing, company registration, and corporate insolvency. 158. In terms of business taxation, the success recorded and reflected in improved administration needs further deepening in order to improve collection performance. Building on the good progress since 2005 to remove red tape, improve tax payer facilitation and lower business interface, the FBR should complement the first phase of ‘outreach’ type reforms with efforts to increase the efficiency and integrity of collections. This would involve: (i) strengthening FBR as an organization, including its structure, governance, business processes, and automation strategy, and (ii) targeting non-compliance through aggressive pursuit of unregistered entities and non-filers. 159. As a complement to more effective administration, the biases in the tax system need to removed to enable a more neutral application of the tax code across activities. In particular, the collection process needs to be buoyed with policy changes to: (i) reduce the complexities in the tax code, (ii) eliminate the exemptions and special treatment of the GST by introducing a VAT, and (iii) balance the tax incidence toward a more equal and wider coverage of the tax base, and away from the heavy reliance on formalized industry. 160. To ease corporate entry, further streamlining of business licensing and property registration areas can be pursued through automation and business process engineering. In the earlier part of the decade, the time for business registration was cut by more than half from 50 days to 24 days. But this has not changed since 2003 and the process remains a paper-based, manual system requiring personal appearance of the applicants. Based on a recent initiative to introduce a nationwide platform to electronically submit the registration forms and company reports required under the law, business process engineering can take place to enable further streamlining. For example, the automation efforts of SECP can be linked with that at FBR to automatically obtain tax IDs and register for sales tax. Further process engineering would require building up the capacities at other agencies, such as the provincial social security agencies and the Employees Old Age Benefits Institution (EOBI). 54 See North (1990). 73 161. Reform of some key business regulations requires an effort to encourage provincial authorities to engage in process analysis and re-engineering. While the primary driver behind tax, trade facilitation, labor inspection, insolvency, access to credit, and contract enforcement is at the national level, the key elements of some business regulation processes such as property registration and construction licensing are implemented at the provincial and district levels.55 Therefore, the federal and provincial governments have requested from the World Bank an effort to analyze sub-national business regulation processes at the provincial and district levels, with a view toward streamlining, implementation and monitoring of results. 162. The legal framework for companies requires a comprehensive revision, particularly of those aspects dealing with insolvency and liquidation. As insolvency has been and is being handled in a piecemeal fashion, the renewed interest and significant reform under way to modernize the Companies Act provides an opportunity to consolidate the various efforts and address aspects of insolvency in a separate law which applies to all entities. The insolvency law should: (i) provide reorganization options and process, including funding during the rescue process and flexibility during its implementation; (ii) protect the asset values of debtors and provide access to and monitoring by all creditors through a creditor’s committee; (iii) allow for automatic liquidation (without court order) in the event of a failed reorganization plan; (iv) incorporate and provide for cross border insolvency; and (v) provide for oversight of insolvency administrators. A complementary effort to build professional capacity is also urgently needed. 163. Over the longer term, business entry, good resource allocation and firm level growth require efforts to strengthen property rights, enforce contracts and provide speedy resolution of corporate disputes. The role of the judiciary has been politicized recently and, as such, has distracted from earlier efforts to strengthen its capacity to deal with business-related issues such as competition law, insolvency, land ownership, and contract enforcement. With the heightened attention to the structural adjustment taking place, the judiciary’ role in a conducive investment climate needs to again take center stage. The provincial nature of the court system is a hindrance for national companies with operations in many parts of the country. Additionally, while commercial benches have been provided, procedures for business-related cases do not exist except in the case of specialized courts for banking and labor. Efforts to strengthen the judiciary are therefore of critical importance. In the short run this would require increasing the capacity of the profession, while over the longer run institutional reforms such as a federal commercial court may be considered. 55 The 2007 Doing Business South Asia report noted that individual cities in Pakistan could significantly improve their global Doing Business ranking by applying the best practices in business regulation found in other Pakistani cities. For example, a deeper analysis found that cities in the Punjab would jump five places if they adopted best Pakistan practice in licenses, and a further four to six places if they adopted best Pakistani practices in registering property. (World Bank, 2007, Doing Business in the Punjab, An Agenda for Sub- National Reform). 74 V. ACHIEVING FLEXIBLE LABOR MARKETS AND ENHANCING SKILLS A. Labor Market Overview 164. The key labor market i+sue is the lack of demand for and supply of skills and a legal/regulatory framework which limits market flexibility and hinders skill development. The strong impact of training and the positive returns on education, especially for higher productivity formal firms, indicates that labor skills are associated with the growth and competitiveness levels of a country—particularly for the labor intensive sectors dominating Pakistan’s industrial structure. Along with labor skills, efficient and effective ways of protecting workers also contribute significantly to global competitiveness. Finally, for the market to work, firms need to have flexibility in making their hiring and firing decisions. Pursuant to these goals, it is essential for labor market regulation to support high levels of efficiency, as its design and implementation have a direct impact on market fluidity, firm level compliance costs and incentives for firms and workers to invest in job training. Thus, despite the fact that firm managers in Pakistan did not report labor regulations and skills as major constraints, a careful examination of labor market aspects is critical to the overall investment climate. 165. The heavy, interventionist approach to labor market regulation creates rigidities, high compliance costs and fosters unequal and unpredictable enforcement. The Doing Business 2009 labor market indicators reveal rigid regulations, particularly in hiring and the cost of firing labor, resulting in a relatively poor ranking for Pakistan on the global rigidity index—at 136th in the world. The out-of-date and overly rigid labor market legislation has high levels of enforcement requirements, compliance cost issues, and leads to reliance on temporary labor and informal markets. Extensive analyses of the legislative and regulatory framework governing the labor market, supported by the on-the-ground experience of the IC survey and global indicators, underscore the assessment that Pakistan has a rigid but un-enforced labor market 166. Despite the low skill levels and market rigidities that characterize the labor market in Pakistan, firms do not consider labor market issues a major obstacle to the investment climate. There is clear evidence that the market rewards higher levels of education, and that investment in labor skills is productivity enhancing. However, three-quarters of Pakistani firm managers do not consider labor market regulations to be an obstacle and more than half of all firms do not consider labor skills to be an obstacle. About a quarter of the firms concede that labor skills are a minor obstacle (Figure 5.1). Figure 5.1: Firm Perceptions of Labor Market Constraints to the Investment Climate Labor market regulation Labor skills 80 70 70 2002 2007 60 2002 2007 60 50 50 40 40 30 30 20 20 10 10 0 0 No obstacle Minor Moderate Major Very severe No obstacle Minor Moderate Major Very severe obstacle obstacle obstacle obstacle obstacle obstacle obstacle obstacle Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2002 and 2007. 75 167. Consistent with firm perceptions, the estimated contribution of labor issues to average productivity is very small, but rises when looking at aggregate productivity. The labor market’s contribution to average productivity (the average or typical firm) is less than 2 percent of the investment climate’s total contribution to productivity (Figure 5.2). The only significant variable in the productivity equation is training programs, which make up around 1.5 percent of the total investment climate contribution, but more than 8 percent of the investment climate’s contribution to aggregate productivity. This fact that labor training contributes accounts for a higher amount of aggregate as compared to average productivity reflects the fact that the positive impact of training on productivity is, in Pakistan, associated with and concentrated in the larger market share firms. Figure 5.2: Contribution of Labor Market Variables to Productivity and Employment By average productivity By aggregate productivity By average employment Staff, female workers Staff, Staff, skilled workers production workers Training to non-production workers Experience of Wage the manager Staff, female Other IC variables workers Education of Other IC Staff, female workers the manager TFP variables Dummy for Dummy for training Other IC vars training Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 168. The labor force participation rate for females has been historically low but is rising as conditions for female employment improve. Recent labor force statistics show the participation rate for males at 87 percent, compared with 22 percent for females (Figure 5.3). Work conditions for women have improved gradually and female labor force participation rose from 17 percent in FY02 to 22 percent in FY06. As a result, while the unemployment rate for male workers was stable, it dropped significantly for females—from 15 percent in FY02 to 9 percent in FY06 (Figure 5.4). Figure 5.3: Labor Force Participation Rates, Figure 5.4: Unemployment Rate, FY02-06 FY01-06 100% 2001/2002 2005/2006 20% 2001/2002 2005/2006 80% 15% 60% 10% 40% 5% 20% 0% 0% All Male Female All Male Female Source: Labor Force Survey (LFS) 2001/2002, LFS 2005/2006 76 169. The labor market is Table 5.1: Employment Status dominated by a large informal sector Urban Rural while participation by labor in the Men Women Men Women formal sector is very small. The Employer 0.01 0.00 0.00 0.00 informal sector, as defined at the Own-account workers 0.26 0.18 0.37 0.17 worker level, consists of workers Unpaid family workers 0.29 0.41 0.27 0.49 without contracts and benefits from Salaried workers 0.24 0.19 0.18 0.14 employers. Based on this definition, Casual wage workers 0.19 0.22 0.18 0.19 the informal sector includes own- Source: LFS 2005/06. account workers, unpaid family workers and casual wage workers. The formal sector only consists of employers and salaried workers and is very small in Pakistan. In urban areas, only 24 percent of working men and 19 percent of working women are salaried workers (Table 5.1). In common with many developing countries, the formal sector is even smaller in rural areas. 170. A large proportion of skilled production workers are salaried employees, but a substantial share of the labor force also work on temporary short term contracts. The IC survey shows that almost a third of Pakistani manufacturing firms hired temporary or seasonal workers. This is more than the 13 percent reported in India and the 28 percent in Sri Lanka, but lower than many other comparators (Figure 5.5). At the same time, contracts are shorter than those in international comparator countries—the average full-time seasonal or temporary worker in Pakistan is employed for just under five months, about the same length of time as in India and Bangladesh but less than in Sri Lanka (Figure 5.6). Figure 5.5: International Comparison of Incidence of Hiring Temporary Workers 70% 60% 50% 40% 30% 20% 10% 0% Pakistan Chile India Turkey Sri Lanka Egypt Brazil Philippines South Africa Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. Figure 5.6: International Comparison of Average Length of Full-time Seasonal/Temporary Employment 10.0 8.0 No of months 6.0 4.0 2.0 0.0 Pakistan Bangladesh Chile India Turkey Sri Lanka Brazil Philippines South Africa Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 77 B. Education and Skill Levels 171. Relative to key comparators, Pakistan’s economy both uses and provides low levels of workers’ education and skills. With respect to several indicators—such as, average years of schooling, percentage of population without schooling, and skill indices—the picture in Pakistan is improving but remains bleak. The indicators, calculated at the beginning of the current decade, placed Pakistan at the low end among comparator countries—better only than Bangladesh in terms of average years of schooling but as poor as the latter in terms of percentage of population without schooling and in skills indices (Table 5.2). The 2007 IC survey recorded half of the total number of employees in firms surveyed as having less than three years of education. This figure is supported by the 2007 Labor Force Survey and is not inconsistent with the Barro-Lee indicators from the year 2000 which showed less than four years of average schooling for workers in the country as a whole. Table 5.2: Workers’ Education and Skills Barro―Lee Education Indicators Harbison―Myers Skills Index Average years Percent of population of schooling without schooling 1998 1985 2000 1985 1960 2000 1985 1960 Rank of 98 score Rank if 98 score Pakistan 3.88 2.14 0.74 51.0 72.8 83.1 77 4.10 69 4.40 Bangladesh 2.58 2.06 0.61 50.1 63.0 87.0 76 4.30 72 3.95 Sri Lanka 6.87 5.88 3.94 14.0 11.9 37.1 58 10.15 52 9.10 Singapore 7.05 6.10 4.30 16.4 28.2 46.2 29 23.05 37 14.08 Malaysia 6.80 5.48 2.88 16.2 23.0 49.7 55 11.10 51 9.20 Thailand 6.50 5.18 4.30 12.6 15.7 36.9 45 14.70 48 10.75 China 6.35 4.94 - 18.0 31.5 - 59 9.75 67 5.15 Philippines 8.21 6.65 4.24 31.0 8.3 25.6 32 21.60 23 21.25 Turkey 5.29 3.69 1.92 20.8 39.1 59.2 49 14.70 50 9.80 Indonesia 4.99 4.00 1.55 32.1 23.6 68.0 56 10.35 57 8.30 India 5.06 3.64 1.68 43.9 61.6 72.2 69 8.10 60 7.10 Mexico 7.23 5.20 2.76 9.7 22.2 40.1 51 12.95 40 13.15 Peru 7.58 6.02 7.58 11.9 17.5 37.6 30 22.55 30 18.40 Brazil 4.88 3.48 4.88 16.0 26.1 47.5 57 10.15 52 9.10 Source: Barro-Lee indicators from Barro, Robert J. and Jong-Wha Lee; International Data on Educational Attainment, Harvard Center for International Development Working Paper no. 42. Harbison-Meyers Skills Index from UNIDO, Industrial Development Report, 2002/2003. 172. The reported average education level of workers in manufacturing and services firms was very low, with services’ employees showing slightly higher education levels. In the manufacturing sector, about 71 percent of employees had zero to three years of education, and another 25 percent had four to six years of schooling. In other words, about 93 percent of employees in the manufacturing sector only had primary or less than primary education, with the level differing very little across industries. Within manufacturing, smaller firms showed less educated employees (two-thirds of employees had less than three years of schooling) compared with medium and large firms (Figure 5.7). The services sector revealed slightly higher education levels with 55 percent employees showing up to six years of education and 41 percent having 7- 78 12 years of schooling. Reflecting Figure 5.7: Average Education Attainment of Workers in Pakistan this supply for labor as well as 100% the demand based on Pakistan’s 13+ yrs low skill-intensive, low- 80% 7-12 yrs technology areas, such as food- 4-6 yrs processing and textile, skilled 60% 0-3 yrs workers only account for only 15 percent of the workforce, and 40% reported to be even lower for 20% smaller firms. 0% 173. Most firms do not Small Medium Large Avg. mfg. Avg. service consider inadequate worker Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. skills an obstacle to the investment climate, with the exception of firms that already have a higher educated workforce. The perception that inadequately educated labor is less pervasive in Pakistan’s than in other countries around the world (Figure 5.8). This perception varied little across different manufacturing industries and different size firms. However, firms in Sindh province considered the lack of an educated work force a more severe obstacle to operations compared to firms in Punjab which considered it a less severe obstacle. At the same time, firm’s which make products requiring a higher educated workforce are more concerned about the availability of skills.56 In other words, the evidence shows that there are firms for which skills are a problem and these are those which manufacture/develop products that demand a more educated workforce. Firms making products which embody lower levels of education, demand lower skills. The finding again demonstrates the low-level equilibrium characterizing the Pakistan labor market that is now beginning to come under pressure with the rising need to compete globally. Figure 5.8: International Comparison of Perception of Inadequately Educated Workforce 100% very severe 90% obstacle 80% major obstacle Proportion of firms 70% moderate 60% obstacle 50% minor obstacle 40% 30% no obstacle 20% 10% 0% Pakistan Bangladesh Chile India Turkey Sri Lanka Egypt Brazil Philippines S. Africa Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 56 Based on the econometric analysis of firm level data in 2007, the hypothesis that firms with a more educated workforce perceive the lack of skills in the workforce as a more sever obstacle is supported 79 174. Despite this narrow demand for a higher educated workers, evidence shows that due the scarce supply of skilled workers, education progressively raises workers’ earnings. Analyses show that the returns to education progressively increase with higher levels of education and are compounded by increased experience. Further, while the average wage levels are lower for women, the premium on education is significantly higher for females than for males, implying a premium based on the scarcity of educated females workers.57 175. Overall, compared with other countries, few Pakistani firms provide formal training, with such training being concentrated among large firms. The proportion of firms offering training is significantly lower in Pakistan than among comparator countries, apart from India. The proportion of firms offering training to workers is less than five percent for all of manufacturing and only slightly higher in the services sector. Within manufacturing, a third of large firms offer training to regular employees and 20 percent offer training to temporary workers—the numbers are comparable with Turkey and Sri Lanka. While a similar proportion of medium firms provide training to regular workers, few among them offer training to temporary workers. Among small firms, training is provided by less than 1 in 20 firms to permanent workers, and 1 in 100 firms to temporary workers (Figure 5.9). Figure 5.9: Provision of Training to Workers International comparison Type of firm South Africa Avg. Philippines service Brazil temp workers Avg. mfg. regular workers Egypt Sri Lanka Large Turkey India Medium Chile Bangladesh Small Pakistan 0% 10% 20% 30% 40% 50% 60% 70% 0% 10% 20% 30% 40% Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 176. Manufacturing firms are more likely to offer training to production workers than non-production workers, while service firms train most of their workforce. Two-thirds of production workers in medium and large firms, and almost half the production workers in small firms, receive training. Large firms offer training to over half their non-production workers, medium firms to a third, and small firms to only five percent of their non-production employees. In the services sector, 80 percent of skilled workers and 70 percent of unskilled workers receive training, with less variance by firm size in the percentage of workers trained (Table 5.3). 57 For example, Aslam 2009 applies various methods in the Pakistan Integrated Household Survey (PIHS) 2001/2002 data, finding that returns to an additional year of schooling range between 7 and 11 percent for men and 13 to 18 percent for women. Kingdon and Soderdom expand the analysis to waged, self-employed and agricultural workers, finding that conditional on occupation, education consistently and substantially raises earnings. 80 Table 5.3: Percentage of Permanent Employees Trained Small Medium Large Total N Avg. N Avg N Avg Total Avg Manufacturing Sector Production workers 10 44.8 12 67.7 42 70.0 64 62.0 Non-production workers 17 5.4 12 36.9 36 58.0 65 23.9 Services Sector Skilled workers 18 80.0 5 82.2 7 74.8 30 79.0 Unskilled workers 19 63.5 5 78.8 7 81.7 31 69.0 Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 177. Firms with a larger share of higher educated workers, tend to invest more in training programs. This is consistent with the hypothesis that firms require workers that can be trained in the use of new technologies. The results also show that the legal status of firms is correlated to their training provisions—sole proprietorships are less likely to invest in training relative to firms with other legal status. Consistent with the earlier analysis, small firms are less likely to provide training compared with medium-size and large firms. These firm-level factors determining the propensity to train are consistent across industries and provinces,58 underlying the fact that not only demand for skills, but action to invest in skills is associated with the higher market share, formalized firms that see a return to training in the form of higher productivity. C. Labor Regulations 178. Pakistan’s labor market efficiency is low by international standards, with statutory requirements causing ‘hiring inflexibility’. Overly strict labor regulation can impair hiring and firing, stifle job creation and lead to higher unemployment. Labor legislation for minimum wages, social benefits and guarantees, employment contracts, and layoff regulations can impact the labor costs that employers face. On the hiring side, according to Doing Business 2010, Pakistan ranks poorly—worse than Philippines, South Africa, Turkey, Bangladesh, Chile, and Thailand. Antiquated regulations governing maximum hours, overtime rates, temporary contracts, and labor taxes59 impact bilateral market relationships and cause real wages to diverge from productivity levels, preventing efficient resource allocation and harming competitiveness. Legislation restricts fixed-term contracts in terms of content and length, allowing only jobs which justify fixed term to be contracted as such and limiting such contracts to a maximum duration of nine months (Figure 5.10). 58 The determinants of investment in training by firms are explored using a logit model with ICS data. Logit specifications are tested―including the firms’ legal status, education characteristics, size, and industry sectors. Workforce composition variables, such as share of productive workers, are also included. 59 For example, currently labor legislation limits temporary contracts―prescribing 48 working and 12 weekly overtime hours, double wages for overtime, a month’s bonus per year, and 40 days of paid leave. It requires five different ‘labor welfare’ taxes from firms and enables various types of inspectors to harass establishments on a regular basis. 81 Figure 5.10: Labor Market Rigidities Hiring and firing difficulty Cost of hiring and firing Firing Sri Lanka Sri Lanka Hiring Egypt Malaysia India Bangladesh Egypt Turkey Vietnam Philippines Thailand Pakistan Chile Vietnam Turkey Malaysia Bangladesh India Nonwage labor cost (% of salary) Firing costs (weeks of wages) South Af rica Thailand Philippines Chile Pakistan Brazil Brazil South Af rica 0 20 40 60 80 100 0 40 80 120 160 200 Source: Doing Business, 2010 (DB 2009 for non-wage labor costs). Firing costs refer to a case where the worker spends 20 years in a firm whereas in Pakistan, the time is generally around 5-7 years, as estimated by the Ministry of Labor and Manpower. 179. Regulations for firing employees are more flexible, but the high costs of firing and the mechanisms for adjudicating labor disputes favor temporary or informal employment. Pakistan ranks slightly better according to the Doing Business indicators, in the difficulty of firing index than in the difficulty of hiring index — it is in theory relatively easier to remove a redundant worker with or without cause in Pakistan compared to most other south Asian countries, including India, Bangladesh and Sri Lanka. In practice, the cost of firing a worker with 20 year experience — higher than the norm for Pakistan, is 90 weeks of wages in Pakistan — higher than in India and many East Asian countries, including Thailand, Vietnam and Malaysia. In addition, the adjudication system involving inspectors, tribunals and authorities contributes to the uncertain and discretionary enforcement outcomes. As a result, firms are more reluctant to hire and invest in permanent workers in anticipation of problems if firms want to fire. 180. The mandate of Pakistan labor laws, that formal sector firms provide certain forms of non-wage benefits, can potentially impose non-negligible costs to employers. These non-wage benefits include the Gratuity or Provident Fund, Provincial Social Security (ESSI), Employment Old Age Benefit (EOBI), group insurance, and Worker’s Profit Participation Fund (WPPF). Among them, ESSI is managed at the provincial level and EOBI is administered at the federal level. Two un- mandated benefits include an education cess and “10C� bonus. Eligible firms are required to pay 5 percent of payroll tax to EOBI, 7 percent of payroll tax to ESSI, implicitly 8.3 percent of payroll tax to Gratuity, and 8.3 percent to 10C bonus (if there is a profit). Firms are also required to purchase group insurance providing coverage up to Rs 200,000 per employee. 82 181. Despite the restrictive nature of the labor regulations, a high proportion of Pakistani firms do not perceive them to be an obstacle to operations; this perception is also higher than it is in comparator countries. Over 70 percent of Pakistani firms perceive labor regulation as no obstacle to their firms’ current operations, compared with 55 percent of firms in India, 44 percent in Bangladesh and 42 percent in Sri Lanka. Though the perception of labor market regulations varies somewhat by firm size, with most small firms perceiving them to be no or minor obstacle, and medium and large firms finding the regulations more severe, the view is consistent across types of manufacturing firms. Service industry firms generally perceive labor market regulations as a more severe obstacle than firms in the manufacturing sector (Figure 5.11). Figure 5.11: Perception of Labor Regulation as Obstacle to Current Operations By international comparison 100% very severe obstacle 90% majoe 80% obstacle 70% moderate Proportion of firms obstacle 60% minor 50% obstacle 40% no obstacle 30% 20% 10% 0% Pakistan Bangladesh Chile India Turkey Sri Lanka Egypt Brazil Philippines South Africa National comparison by firm size 90% very severe 80% obstacle major 70% Proportion of firms obstacle 60% moderate obstacle 50% no obstacle 40% 30% 20% 10% 0% Small Medium Large Avg. mfg. Avg.service Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 182. Deeper empirical investigation reveals that firms with more educated workers, on average, perceive labor regulations to be more binding on their operations. Firms with a labor force averaging four to six years of education perceive labor regulations as a more severe obstacle than other types of firms, after controlling for other factors.60 The finding is consistent 60 Regression analysis was conducted with ‘perception of labor regulation as an obstacle to current operation’ as a dependent variable. This variable was scaled from 0 to 4, with 0 as no obstacle and 4 as a very severe obstacle. 83 with earlier results describing that firms with a higher education labor profile also find labor skills more of an investment climate issue, compared with other firms in the economy. 183. In contrast to the similar views across size groups, firms in different states have more variance in their perceptions of labor regulation as an obstacle to current operations. Compared to firms in Baluchistan and Sindh, firms in Punjab view labor regulations as a less severe obstacle. The perception varies insignificantly among different industries, except that the non-metallic minerals industry perceives labor regulations to be even less of an issue than the rest. Such differences imply that the enforcement of labor regulations, traditionally left to provincial level governments, varies across provinces. The differential impact of discretion applied at the provincial level by inspectors, labor tribunals and wage authorities in enforcing requirements and adjudicating, adds policy and governance dimensions to location-specific differences in the investment climate. 184. The existence of favorable perceptions by firm managers regarding labor regulations reflects difficulties in the enforcement of a complex, rigid and antiquated labor code. However, the perceived low or no obstacle perception about labor regulation does not necessarily imply that labor market regulation is not an issue in Pakistan. One fundamental reason is the disparity between the current state of the labor code and it relation to the most policy recent statement, the Government’s Labor Policy 2002. While the 2002 labor policy is meant to cover a wide range of workers through a market friendly approach, the labor code, through its restrictions on firm autonomy and costly requirements, encourages firms to circumvent labor laws, often by often using contracted or piece-rate labor, commonly hired through intermediaries, on a very short-term basis. Such practices, while achieving flexibility and avoiding costs of complying with labor regulation, suppresses labor productivity and keeps Pakistan’s economy concentrated in low value-added activities. 185. Though the provisions in the legislation are strict, legislative enforcement is relatively weak, discretionary and therefore open to abuse, with implications for labor market outcomes. The uneven and generally weak enforcement of labor laws is a likely reason why firms do not consider labor market regulation a critical barrier. Another is that it does not seem to be difficult to substituted unofficial payments for the cost of compliance with the law. Compared with other countries, 48 percent of Pakistani firms were inspected by labor department officials, a figure that was only higher than Bangladesh (45 percent) and Turkey (34 percent). Inspections were most frequent in large and medium-size firms (85 percent and 83 percent, respectively). Among the firms inspected, the average number of visits in the past 12 months was 2.9 in the manufacturing industry and 3.3 in the services industry. This is higher than that in Bangladesh (1.0) and India (1.6) but much lower than that in Sri-Lanka (7.0). Not only was the number of inspections limited, more than half of firms inspected were expected or were requested to make informal payments or gifts to the inspectors. This result is significantly higher than for all other comparator countries, except India (Figure 5.12). Thus the evidence is that labor regulations are non-binding for most, and for those who do face inspectors can become non-binding for a fee. 84 Figure 5.12: Labor Inspections 100% 9.0 Inspected Firms Informal Payments No. Inspections 75% 6.0 50% 3.0 25% 0% 0.0 Turkey Bangladesh Pakistan Philippines South Africa Sri Lanka India Egypt Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 186. Similarly, despite the fact that benefits are mandated for workers, the benefit coverage of Pakistan’s labor force is limited. On average, a higher proportion of large firms provide benefits to their employees, ranging from 85.7 percent for Provident Fund, 89.8 percent for Provincial Social Security, 70.2 percent for group insurance, 88.6 percent for EOBI, and only 56.4 percent for WPPF. A smaller percentage of medium-size firms and small firms provide various benefits (Table 5.4). Most firms, if they do provide benefits, do so for all regular employees. The incidence of partial coverage (covering some employees but not all employees) is very low. Evidence indicates that benefits are more likely to be provided by large- and medium-size firms and by public-listed and limited companies, by a factor of 7-9 times over sole proprietorships. Firms in the textiles and garment industries are less likely to provide mandated benefits, as are firms in Baluchistan. Table 5.4: Benefits Coverage In percent Small Medium Large Mfg Services Partial coverage 5.6 49.0 79.8 12.4 9.7 Gratuity or Provident fund 100% coverage 11.8 51.5 85.7 19.2 11.7 Partial coverage 28.9 78.3 82.6 35.6 27.0 Provincial Social Security 100% coverage 35.4 79.0 89.8 42.7 29.2 Partial coverage 2.5 43.7 65.0 8.3 6.8 Group Insurance 100% coverage 7.8 44.2 70.2 14.0 8.7 Partial coverage 25.6 80.1 84.6 32.2 28.2 Employee Old Age Benefit(EOBI) 100% coverage 32.0 85.7 88.6 39.2 30.2 Partial coverage 3.7 25.5 47.9 7.1 8.1 Workers Profit Participation Fund 100% coverage 9.4 25.9 56.4 13.5 9.7 Partial coverage 2.3 12.8 60.9 6.0 7.1 Education Cess 100% coverage 10.4 24.5 65.9 15.4 8.5 Partial coverage 4.7 26.0 71.8 9.6 9.4 10C Bonus 100% coverage 11.4 31.0 76.6 16.8 12.7 Source: The World Bank. Labor Market Study, 2006. 85 D. Hiring Practices 187. The incidence of employing temporary workers is high in Pakistan. In the FY06-07 period, 34 percent of medium-sized firms reported having hired at least one Figure 5.13: Firms Hiring Temporary Workers temporary worker, compared with 22 35% percent of small firms and 30 percent of 30% large firms. On average, more firms in 25% the services sector hired temporary 20% workers (27 percent) compared with 15% firms in the manufacturing sector (22 10% percent) (Figure 5.13). The high 5% incidence of hiring temporary workers 0% presumably reflects the strict labor Small Medium Large Avg. mfg. Avg. market regulations that apply to service permanent employees. Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 188. One of the main reasons cited by firms for relying heavily on temporary workers was to avoid incurring costs associated with providing various benefits to permanent workers. Firms are legally required to provide social security benefits to temporary workers. However, many firms manage to circumvent this law by various means.61 This is further proved by other studies which show that temporary workers put in longer hours under poorer conditions and are denied health insurance coverage, accident compensation and other welfare measures.62 189. Firms providing some or all mandated benefits to permanent workers are more likely to hire temporary workers. This association is tested in the following logistic regression. Specifically, firms providing some mandated benefits are 1.85 times more likely to hire temporary workers and firms providing all mandated benefits are 2.61 times more likely to hire temporary workers. The finding shows that if firms have to provide mandated benefits, they tend to hire temporary workers to reduce the higher incurred costs. Such practice may hamper employment growth in the long run. 190. Firms with a more educated workforce are less likely to hire temporary workers, holding other factors constant. This is probably due to the fact that there is less substitution between temporary workers and regular workers if regular workers are more educated. After controlling for other factors, firm size is not a significant factor in determining firms’ hiring of temporary workers. Sole proprietorships are least likely to hire temporary workers. Firms in the garment industry are more likely to hire temporary workers while firms in the non-metallic industry are least likely to hire temporary workers. This practice also significantly varies by states. Compared with firms in Baluchistan, firms in Sindh province are 3.12 times more likely and firms in Punjab province are 5.6 times more likely to hire temporary workers. 191. Most firms in Pakistan hire new employees through family or friends. About 53 percent of firms in the manufacturing sector and about 79 percent of firms in the services sector 61 World Bank, 2006. 62 Ilahi, Naqvi et al, 1995. 86 hire new employees through family or friend networks (Figure 5.14). Other studies using labor force survey data, support this finding, and shows that a person’s employment status (formal or informal) is significantly associated with other family members’ employment status.63 Figure 5.14: Firms Hiring Temporary Workers 80% manufacture service 70% 60% 50% 40% 30% 20% 10% 0% Through Public Private Public School/industry Contractor/ Other family/friends placement office placement office advertisement related network Theykedar Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 192. Firms in the manufacturing sector also rely on ‘theykedars’ to find workers, mostly temporary workers. Firms report that the benefits of hiring through ‘Theykedars’ include: reduced costs of recruiting, reduced labor costs (lower wages and benefits), and lower compliance costs (of regulation) including time managers’ take to comply with regulations either officially or unofficially. This shows that informal channels of hiring employees are quite prevalent in Pakistan in order for firms to reduce the cost of hiring. The predominance of these channels increases labor market inefficiency and limits the mobility of workers. Moreover, limited mobility of the workers is due to firm specific skills and location close to home. Thus, more efforts should be focused on creating a more public, accessible and transparent job placement solution. E. The Way Forward 193. Education and skills development of workers, and increasing the fluidity in labor markets, are the current goals of the GoP’s efforts. Pakistan’s antiquated and restrictive regulations governing maximum hours, overtime conditions, length of temporary contracts, remuneration rates, and welfare contributions impact bilateral market relationships and cause real wages to diverge from productivity levels, preventing efficient resource allocation and harming competitiveness. The discretionary approach of provincial inspectors, labor tribunals and wage authorities in enforcing requirements and adjudicating disputes adds considerable uncertainty to labor market outcomes. The result is that many, if not most firms circumvent labor laws to some degree, often by using contracted or piece-rate labor hired through intermediaries, on a very short term basis. Such practice, while avoiding costs of complying with labor regulation, suppresses labor productivity and keeps Pakistan’s economy concentrated in low value-added activities. 63 Hou, 2008. 87 194. Based on mutually reinforcing goals of quality employment generation, labor protection and improved competitiveness, a major labor code reform is underway. Considerable effort is being made to modernize the labor code following the principals specified in the Labor Policy of 2002, including: (i) bilateralism; (ii) consolidation of laws along functional lines; (iii) accessible and speedy justice for labor disputes; (iv) conforming with ILO conventions; (v) flexibility in hiring and firing; and (vi) improved labor welfare. Practically the entire set of laws and the hundreds of associated regulations, many predating independence, are being reviewed and consolidated into five principal laws covering: (i) industrial relations, (ii) employment conditions, (iii) occupational safety and health, (iv) labor welfare and social safety, and (iv) human resource development. 195. The first major steps have been taken in terms of the legislative process, with a pipeline of major activities about to be launched. Parliament passed a new Industrial Relations Act (IRA) that was finalized and approved in November 2008. A draft Employment and Service Conditions Act (ESCA) has been created by consolidating 14 separate laws governing conditions of employment (including wages) for a number of sectors.64 In drafting the ESCA, the Government pursued an approach which: (i) consolidated existing texts; (ii) removed overlaps and inconsistencies; and (iii) adjusted some of the provisions to allow a greater degree of flexibility, particularly on the hiring side. ESCA has gone through one round of consultations and revision and will go through a second round in the coming months. The Occupational Safety and Health Act (OSHA) has been drafted, but not yet been presented to stakeholders for review. In all cases, the costs of hiring and firing should be continuously taken into account with an attempt to balance minimized costs with enforcement of the public interest. 196. The enforcement of these combined federal laws will require complementary reforms – including (i) in the area of unemployment benefits and other safety net policies and (ii) in the inspection regime which ensures minimized red-tape, bureaucratic hassles and extra costs on businesses. Since the enforcement of the labor laws was traditionally left to the provinces, their application was uneven across the country, leading to policy differences in the investment climate in different parts of Pakistan. Therefore, the federal Government is planning to be proactive in developing and encouraging a unified approach to the provincial enforcement of labor laws―in part guided by two recently passed national policies: the Labor Inspection and Labor Protection policies of 2007. 197. The labor inspection policy framework should support commitments under the Labor Policy 2002 and Labor Protection 2005 to reorganize and streamline the labor inspection services. This is especially important at the provincial level. The federal government and the provincial governments need to coordinate with each other to develop the capacity of provincial labor inspections and help them become more effective. Interventions are needed to develop the capacity of employers and workers to adjust to the new approaches for inspection. At the federal level, the Ministry of Labor will be revitalizing the reform of labor inspection services, in line with the international labor standards. 64 The earlier laws include: (i) Children (Pledging of Labor ) Act, 1933; (ii) The Payment of Wages Act, 1936; (iii) The Employment (Record of Service) Act, 1951; (iv) Coal Mines (fixation of rate of wages) Ordinance, 1960; (v) The Minimum Wages Ordinance, 1961; (vi) The West Pakistan Industrial and Commercial Employment (Standing Orders), 1968; (vii) The West Pakistan Shops and Establishments Ordinance, 1969; (viii) The Minimum Wages for Unskilled Worker Ordinance, 1963; (ix) The Workers Cost of Living (Relief) Act, 1973; and (x) The Employment of Children Act, 1994. The authorities also report that relevant portions of The Factories Act, 1934 (those covering employment conditions, wages, etc.) will be replaced, while the other portions of The Factories Act will be incorporated into the new Health and Safety Act under preparation. 88 198. Public policies are also needed to enhance governance and combat corruption during inspection. The ICS findings show that Pakistan has a high incidence of inspectors asking for gifts or informal payments during inspections. Incentives, both rewards and punishment, need to be in place to ensure the effectiveness of inspections. Empowering employers and workers is a bottom-up approach to increasing inspection transparency. 199. Strengthening the public and private provision of the educational system is a fundamental necessity for promoting innovation and improving productivity. Positive returns to higher education, in terms of wages and productivity, imply that improving education should be a central element of a competitiveness strategy. Extensive interventions, many of them innovative ones, have been attempted, including school establishment grants, school management and teacher training programs, public and private partnerships in education provision, and conditional cash transfer programs for poor households. 200. Providing incentives to increase firm training is important to promote innovations and enhance firm productivity. The ICS findings suggest that small firms need to be the primary target of these incentives. Small firms have limited capacity to offer training to their employees. Thus, it makes sense to increase the economies of scale and offer training through small firms in a collaborative way. This can be organized by non-governmental organizations (NGOs) or public private partnerships (PPPs), or solely by private organizations. However, proactive measures are needed to reach these small firms. 201. Emphasis is needed to foster transferable skills through training programs. Transferable skills can promote workers’ flexibility and mobility across different sectors, and promote innovations. In most cases, workers at SMEs acquire firm specific skills from on the job training which are non-transferable in most cases. Given the common nature of transferable skills, collaborative training offered by third parties can increase the economies of scale. Public policy needs to endorse and facilitate the creation and delivery of these training programs. In particular, the Ministry of Labor has prepared a Human Resource Development policy which is under consultation which aims to highlight the issues found in the education and training of the country’s labor force – recommending industry-academia linkages, facilitating on the job training and starting of an apprenticeship program. 202. The collection and proper use of statistics can help to provide policy makers and analyst with useful information for decision making. For example, a Labor Market Information System can be established, either as a government activity, or with some additional effort and cost, a public – private partnership whereby labor market information is collected and updated by the private sector for the benefit of the private sector, with government assistance in organization, facilitation and oversight. 89 VI. EXPANDING CORPORATE ACCESS TO FINANCE A. Overview of the Financial Sector 203. Pakistan’s financial sector is dominated by banking activity, reflecting in part the country’s current stage of development as well as the Government’s recent focus on reforms. Financial sector development has focused primarily on fundamental reforms in banking, initiated in the early 1990s and accelerated during the early 2000s. Privatized and restructured banks, strengthened prudential regulations and supervision, reforms to strengthen loan recovery, and improved corporate governance have been the hallmarks of Pakistan’s financial sector development over the past decade. Banks now account for 95 percent of financial institution assets, as non-bank financial institutions involved in leasing, underwriting, venture capital, insurance, and pensions currently play a limited role in the financial sector. Government securities dominate the debt market and bank stocks dominate the equity market, accounting for 40 percent of the stock market’s capitalization. 204. Since Pakistan’s banking sector has been one the fastest growing and most profitable in the region, the bulk of the sector has so far been cushioned against the macroeconomic stress. Banking assets rose three-fold during the first five years of the decade—from 47.2 percent of GDP in 2000 to 55.6 percent of GDP in 2005. In 2006, profitability was high with a return on banking assets of 2.6 percent and a return on equity of 25.4 percent. At the same time, capital adequacy rose from 11.1 percent at the end of 2003 to around 14 percent at the end of 2007.65 Despite these aggregate strong numbers, there are in fact a number of weak banks in the system. Although the number of conventional commercial banks dropped from 41 to 29 in recent years, through mergers, acquisitions and closures, further consolidation is expected due to the yearly increases in capital required by the central bank. The banking sector seems to have weathered the downturn well by providing for impaired assets and becoming more conservative in its credit extension, particularly as fiscal financing have provided a high return, low risk alternative. 205. Despite this strong picture of Pakistan’s financial sector, some new risks may be emerging. Corporate lending traditionally accounted for about 59 percent of bank loans but in recent years, consumer lending became the most rapidly growing component of bank portfolios. However, the recent macroeconomic instability is leading to increased defaults, particularly in consumer-lending, but also in the corporate sector. In particular, defaults in the textiles sector have increased recently, and non-performing loans (NPLs) also rose in FY08―from under 6 percent of assets at the end of FY06 to almost 7 percent. In addition, while some of the NPLs certainly stem from forces which are cyclical in nature, banks are also heavily exposed to new and more complex risks stemming from large exposures and new business practices. B. The Importance of Finance to Competitiveness 206. Access to credit for working capital and investment finance can have a positive impact on productivity and employment growth. The economic estimate of the investment climate’s contribution to productivity shows that external finance plays an important role in growth. In particular, access to bank finance is positively and significantly associated with 65 As a result of the introduction of Basel II principles, capital adequacy declined to 12.4 percent at the end of FY08, as opposed to the 14 percent ration which would have been recorded in the absence of Basel II. 90 average productivity, while financing from internal funds, family and friends, and informal sources is negatively associated with growth. As a result, finance accounts for 17 percent of both average and aggregate firm productivity in Pakistan, though through somewhat different variables (Figure 6.1).66 Specifically, working capital finance from banks contributes less than 2 percent to average productivity but rises to 7.4 percent in the aggregate, while financing by internal funds contributes 8.4 to average productivity but falls to 4.3 percent in the aggregate. This distinction implies that the positive productivity impact of formalized finance (banks) is more prevalent in higher market share firms, while the negative impact of more informal methods of finance is associated with smaller market share firms. Figure 6.1: Contribution of Finance Variables to Productivity and Employment By average productivity By aggregate productivity By average employment Working capital Working capital Working capital financed by financed by financed by internal Purchases paid Working capital internal founds private banks founds before delivery financed by private Purchases paid Working capital Sales paid for banks Working capital before delivery financed by after delivery financed by family/friends TFP Working capital financed family/friends by state-owned banks Working capital Working capital Wages financed by financed by informal Dummy for checking informal founds founds or saving account Dummy for Other IC Owner of the lands checking or Dummy for Other IC saving account checking or saving Dummy for Other IC variables variables account credit line Dummy for external auditory Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 207. Financial sector reforms have had a Figure 6.2: Access to Finance as a Major or Severe significant positive impact during the 2000 Obstacle decade but Pakistani firms still find it more By international comparison problematic to access finance compared to Brazil firms in other countries. Between 2002 and Bangladesh Pakistan 2006, the percentage of firms citing access to Egypt Chile finance as a ‘severe’ obstacle to their operations Malaysia fell from over 31 percent to just 6 percent, and Indonesia India the percentage of firms that viewed finance as Thailand Sri Lanka ‘no’ obstacle increased from over 17 percent to Greece 36 percent. Still, even as the severity of finance Vietnam South Africa as an obstacle has lessened considerably, over a 0 10 20 30 40 Pe rce ntage of forms 50 60 third of firms in Pakistan continue to rank By comparison time access to financial services as a ‘major obstacle’ (as opposed to a severe one), surpassed only by 60 50 No Obstacle Minor Obstacle Major Obstacle Severe Obstacle Brazil and Bangladesh among comparator P ercentag e 40 countries (Figure 6.2). 30 20 10 0 Pakistan 2002 Pakistan 2006 Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 66 In a sample from Eastern Europe, firms that gained access to bank credit for investment and working capital from 2002-05 registered 9 percent higher growth in employment and a 36 percent growth in revenue. The employment effect was even bigger for small firms of less than 20 employees. 91 C. Financial Market Depth at the Firm Level Figure 6.3: Financial Depth Domestic credit as percentage of GDP 208. The financial market in Pakistan is relatively Malaysia shallow as firms rely on retained earnings to finance 67 Vietnam their working capital and investment needs. Domestic Chile credit to the private sector amounts to 29 percent of GDP, less than in 11 out of 13 comparator countries in terms of South Africa financial depth—including India, Bangladesh and Sri Thailand Lanka. Only Indonesia and the Philippines have more Greece shallow financial systems (Figure 6.3). Retained earnings Egypt being the predominant form of finance in Pakistan is not dissimilar to other middle and low-income countries. Brazil Pakistan’s firms rely less on banks and on trade credit than India firms in comparator countries, ranking behind only Egypt in Bangladesh share of working capital financed from both retained Pakistan earnings and commercial banks (Figure 6.4). Compared to Indonesia other South Asian countries, 6.5 percent of working capital needs are financed by commercial banks (32 percent, 21 Philippines percent and 16 percent in Bangladesh, Sri Lanka, and India 0 20 40 60 80 100 120 respectively). The pattern of funding from retained earnings Percentage is robust across regions and industries, ranging from 88 Source: World Development Indicators, 2007. percent in NWFP to 78 percent in Sindh. Figure 6.4: Sources of Working Capital Finance Retained earnings Commercial banks 100 50 80 40 Percentage Percentage 60 30 40 20 20 10 0 0 ia es d dia a m ka ile sh t n il yp ric an az a ta a nd s sh a a an m ys le t na il yp Ch pin de an ne ric si di nk az In Eg kis na hi Br Af ail de la st ala ay et In Eg Af iL pi La C la Br i lip ai ki et Th Pa la Vi h al ilip ng M Th Pa Sr h Vi ut ng i M Ph Sr ut Ph Ba So Ba So Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 209. Trade credit plays a smaller role in working capital financing relative to comparator countries, particularly given Pakistani firms’ reliance on internal funds. Though higher than India and Bangladesh, trade credit as a share of working capital finance is still lower in Pakistan than in many other countries like South Africa, Thailand, Chile, and Malaysia. In the latter countries, trade credit plays a significant role in allowing firms to manage liquidity constraints over short-time horizons, particularly in the absence of access to overdraft facilities or credit lines. However, large Pakistani 67 Financial depth measures the overall availability of financial resources for the economy and for firms. In essence, depth is an aggregate measure which captures total financial resources for the economy, as well as for an average firm. Measures of depth included in this report are private credit/GDP (overall depth), and the percentage of firm financing needs that are met with external sources of finance. 92 firms, that are often the main source of supplier financing, cite lack of legal enforcement and incomplete credit information as key barriers to supplier credit (Figure 6.5). Figure 6.5: Trade Credit as a Source of Working Capital Share of working capital financed by trade credit Reasons stated by Pakistan firms for zero credit sales Malaysia 1.0 Cash Flow No experience Chile No confidence in law No credit worthiness info Brazil 0.8 Thailand Percentage South Africa 0.6 Philippines Sri Lanka 0.4 Pakistan 0.2 India Vietnam 0.0 Bangladesh Small Medium Large Egypt 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 Percentage working capital financing Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 210. Investment is also primarily self-financed—three-quarters of investment is financed from retained earnings and only 15 percent from commercial banks. Perhaps even more so than in the case of working capital finance, access to commercial sources of investment funds is important as firms upgrade technology, infrastructure, and machinery in order to increase productivity. As with working capital, Pakistan’s firms rely less on external sources of investment relative to global comparators (Figure 6.6). Figure 6.6: Sources of Investment Finance Domestic sources of investment finance Share of investment finance from commercial banks 100 60 80 40 Percentage Percentage 60 40 20 20 0 0 Internal Commercial State Non-Bank Inst Other il a ile t m Th ia n s a ka nd sh yp az di ne ta ri c Funds Banks Banks/Gvt na s Ch an de In la Eg ay Br k is pi Af et ai iL al la ili p Pa Vi h ng M Sr ut Ph Ba So Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 211. Financing patterns do not differ much across provinces but do so significantly among firms across sectors. For example, the metals and machinery sector relies the most on internal funds to finance investments, borrows primarily from state-owned banks, and has the highest share of loan rejections. In contrast, the chemicals, sporting goods, and food sectors are better able to secure commercial bank financing relative to other sectors (Figure 6.7). 93 Figure 6.7: Financing Patterns by Manufacturing and Services Sectors Financing the purchase of fixed assets g Financial institution granting a loan Applyingyfor loans/line of credits pp g g 2.15 1 0 20 40 60 80 100 2 .8 1.5 1.42 1.25 1.26 .6 % % 1 .4 0.44 0.50 0.50 .5 .2 0.24 0.06 0.13 0.13 0.00 0 0 s r od ls y s he s r r od s ls ry es od od er ls ry s ic e ica he he od od ice Fo ica ica ne ne h in at ic Fo go Fo rv at at em go go rv Le hi rv em hi Se em Le ac Le ts Se ac Se ts Ch ac & ts or M Ch & Ch M or & M or ts Sp & ts Sp & en ts Sp & al en al en rm et al m et M m et Ga ar M ar M G s, G s, ile tile s, xt ile x Te Te xt Te Number of Times Applied Number of Times Rejected Commercial Banks State-Owned Banks Internal Funds Commercial Banks Non-Bank Financial Institutions Other State Banks/Govt Agencies Other Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. D. Financial Sector Outreach for Manufacturing and Services 212. In addition to low levels of financial depth, the economy exhibits limited financial sector outreach to households as well as firms. Evidence of this underperformance by the financial sector comes from the recent pronouncement by the State Bank of Pakistan that only 17 percent of the population holds bank accounts and less than 4 percent are borrowers in the system.68 In terms of per capita loan accounts—combining consumer and firm loans to proxy the overall use of credit services—Pakistan has 22 loan accounts per capita, compared to 55 in Bangladesh, 50 in Brazil and 247 in Thailand.69 The number of bank branches and ATMs is low geographically, relative to comparator countries and even lower in a demographic sense (Figure 6.8). Data from the country suggests that fewer Pakistani firms have or use a line of credit/overdraft compared to firms in other countries in the region (30 percent in Pakistan, compared with 60 percent in Sri Lanka and 70 percent in Bangladesh) and around the globe (Figure 6.9). Figure 6.8: Outreach by Banks’ Branches and ATMs By branch penetration By ATM penetration 50 47.5 12 10.91 40 30.8 9 30 25.5 22.6 20.4 20 14.6 6 9.4 9.8 9.1 10.0 8.4 3.67 10 6.0 7.4 4.7 6.9 6.3 4.5 2.0 2.2 2.5 3.6 3.1 3 0 0.61 1.02 0.53 0.06 sh a sia a a 0 l e n pt sia le zi ric di ec nk ta hi de gy ra ne In ay is Af La C re B Bangladesh Pakistan Sri Lanka E la ak do al G h ng ri M P ut In S Ba So Geographic (per 1,000 km sq) Demographic (per 100,000 people) Geographic (per 1,000 km sq) Demographic (per 100,000 people) Source: Pakistan Economic Survey, 2007/08. 68 Speech by Dr. Shamshad Akhtar, Governor of the State Bank of Pakistan, July 1, 2008. 69 Data taken from ‘Reaching Out’ database. 94 Figure 6.9: Measures of Financial Outreach Across Countries By loan accounts per capita By overdraft facility or line of credit 800 1.0 600 0.8 0.6 400 0.4 200 0.2 0 0.0 Egypt Philippines Pakistan Vietnam Sri Lanka Bangladesh Brazil Thailand South Pakistan Bangladesh Malaysia Greece Africa Source: Reaching Out Database, 2007. 213. Efforts to increase financing to SMEs Table 6.1: Bank Lending to Sectors have had some effect but lending is still highly Sectors 2004 2005 2006 2007 concentrated in terms of types and number of Corporate 53.9 52.7 53.3 56.3 borrowers. The State Bank of Pakistan established a SMEs 17.5 17.7 17.0 16.2 separate SME department in 2005, drafted separate Agriculture 7.4 6.8 5.9 5.6 prudential regulations for SMEs, relaxed collateral Consumer 9.4 12.4 13.5 13.8 requirements, and directed banks to establish Commodity 7.5 6.9 7.2 5.5 departments for handling SME financing. The Staff Loans 2.5 2.1 2.0 1.9 number of borrowers in the sector now exceeds Other 1.8 1.5 1.1 0.8 185,000, compared with 67,000 SME borrowers in Source: The World Bank, Access to Finance, 2008. 2002. Still, as a percentage of bank lending, loans to SMEs fell from 17.5 to 16.2 percent between 2004 Figure 6.10: Measures of Financial Outreach and 2007 (Table 6.1). Portfolios are also skewed Across Countries toward a few borrowers: 0.4 percent of borrowers Accessing Various Types of Banking Products account for 65 percent of credit, with 5 million borrowers accounting for the remaining one-third.70 Large 214. Small and medium firms show Medium significantly lower rates of usage of all types of banking products as compared to large firms. The checking/savings acct Small overdraft facility pattern is consistent whether in terms of use of line of credit or loan banking products or in terms of reliance on credit 0.0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 from commercial banks (Figure 6.10). Still, a lower Accessing Working Capital from Commercial level of observed use of financial services does not, Banks in itself, indicate a problem of access. On the 20 borrower’s side, exclusion may be the result of low 15 levels of financial literacy, a response to systematic Percentage discrimination in the past, or maybe just a question 10 of lower demand. On the lender’s side, creditors face macroeconomic, market and individual borrower 5 risks which may rationally make lending to smaller 0 firms more difficult. Well-known problems of Small Medium Large Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 70 Access to Finance in Pakistan, 2008. 95 adverse selection, moral hazard, and contract Figure 6.11: Access to Finance by Firm-size enforcement are more prevalent among smaller By applying for loans/lines of credit firms—this, in itself, may lead to loans being denied as a matter of prudent underwriting Large criteria. Medium 215. Information from the firms in Pakistan suggests that low usage of financial Small and credit products by Pakistani firms may be a result of low demand. Six percent of small 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 firms and 12 percent of medium-sized firms By result of loan applications applied for loans or lines of credit, compared with 30 percent of large firms, in FY07. Small 2.0 No. of times applied No. of times rejected firms were only marginally more likely to have 1.6 their loan applications rejected compared to 1.2 large firms (Figure 6.11). Interestingly, firm investment patterns were consistent with loan 0.8 application and use patterns. Ten and 30 percent 0.4 of small and medium-sized firms, respectively, 0.0 purchased fixed assets, while 50 percent of Small Medium Large large firms made similar investments in fixed Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. assets. 216. The predominant reason cited by firms for opting out of the formal credit market was low demand; the pattern largely held across firm size. Almost two-thirds of firms reported lack of need as their main reason for not applying for loans. However, about a quarter of the firms pointed to the high interest rates as being a deterrent to borrowing from the formal credit market. Given the environment of easy financing and low interest rates that existed at the time of the survey, this response from the firms is a sign of the ineffective demand for credit. As might be expected, small and medium-sized firms were more likely to point to interest rates as the reason for not applying for loans, as compared to large firms (Figure 6.12). Figure 6.12: Main Reasons for not Applying for Loans or Lines of Credit Percent of respondents Insufficient Size of Loan High Collateral Small Medium Large Complex Application No Need 56 72 63 Unlikely to be Procedures 5 0 3 Approved Unfavorable Interest Rates 26 20 13 Interest rates No Need Collateral 5 0 4 Other Loan Size/Term 0 0 2 Expect Rejection 1 1 0 Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 96 E. Cost and Terms of Borrowing 217. In addition to financial sector outreach and depth, it is important to examine the terms and conditions associated with credit products. Overly-burdensome underwriting requirements or loan products that are inconsistent with firms’ needs may be among the factors driving financial exclusion or low credit use. For example, very high collateral requirements would affect both depth and outreach by limiting loan amounts for all firms and by excluding some firms that may not have sufficient collateral to fulfill financing contracts. 218. While high interest rates appears to deter some firms from participating in the credit markets, lending rates are relatively low in real terms as are processing fees. In addition to nominal interest rates, loan costs are also embedded in processing fees. Recent data from the Getting Finance indicators suggest that processing fees for business start-up loans in Pakistan are relatively low compared to neighboring countries (Figure 6.13). Figure 6.13: Cost of Borrowing Lending interest rates Processing fees for start-up loans 1 45 1.0 40 0.8 35 0.8 30 Percentage 25 0.6 0.6 20 % 15 0.4 0.3 10 5 0 0.2 a a ia il an a le do t ka h e nd yp az ri c si si So des ec Ba Ind hi an st la ne ay Eg 0.0 Br C Af re ki ai iL la al G Pa Th h ng M Sr ut Pakistan Bangladesh Sri Lanka India In Source: World Bank, Getting Finance Indicators, 2008. 219. The terms of loans in Pakistan are, on average, much shorter compared to credit product terms offered in neighboring countries, while the loan size is larger. Although more than half of all loans have tenures of less than one year, the average loan size, relative to per capita income in Pakistan, is substantially higher than what is observed in other emerging market economies (Figure 6.14). The shorter duration and larger loans underscore the riskiness in the banking environment, which itself is reflected in the less prevalent lending to smaller clients. Figure 6.14: Loan Duration and Size By duration of loan term By loan/income ratio 15 70 60 10 50 Months 40 30 5 20 10 0 0 l m pt ca es an a sh zi a nd sh e an nk le il na y a in si de ri st ec az Eg Br hi La Af de la st ay pp ki et la re C Br ai ki Pa Vi th la al ili i ng Sr G Th Pa Ph u ng M Ba So Ba Source: Reaching Out Database, 2007, Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 97 220. Firms in Pakistan face higher and more ubiquitous collateral requirements compared to global competitors, which can impact financial access and depth. Ninety percent of firms are required to provide collaterals as security for their loans, compared to 70 percent in India and Bangladesh. In addition, the value of the collaterals, relative to the loan size, is also higher in Pakistan (134.5 percent) compared to India (129.7 percent), Sri Lanka (106 percent), and Bangladesh (94.6 percent)―as well as Philippines, Malaysia, Thailand, Chile, Brazil, and Egypt (Figure 6.14). Collateral requirements are a cross-cutting issue for all firms—with SMEs and various sectors facing similar collateral requirements. 221. Studies have shown that it is not necessarily the value of collateral required to secure a loan that reduces access, but rather the type of collateral that is acceptable to a bank. Restrictions on the use of movable property as collateral preclude firms from leveraging their assets in a productive manner. In general, banks usually require immovable property such as land or buildings to secure a loan (Figure 6.15), while most firms’ property and assets are vested in movable property such as machinery, inventory, or accounts receivable. In Pakistan, SMEs are generally much less likely to use movable property as security, compared to large firms. One reason for this may lie in the restrictive policy environment that only allows firms registered in the companies registry to secure loans using movable property—putting SMEs at a disadvantage. Figure 6.15: Collateral Usage in Lending Collateral as percent of loan Type of collateral required for a loan 175 1.0 Land/Buildings Machinery/Equipment 140 0.8 Receivables/Inventory Percentage 105 Personal Assets 0.6 Other 70 0.4 35 0 0.2 a nd l sh t le ka ca m n ia es i yp di az ta i na ys Ch la de an ri In n Eg Br kis Af pi ai a 0.0 et iL la al ilip Th Pa Vi h ng M Sr ut Ph Ba Small Medium Large So Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 222. Indications are that while fees and interest rates are relatively competitive in Pakistan, the actual process of obtaining a loan can nonetheless be cumbersome. It takes, on average, more than 11 days for a loan application to be processed (Figure 6.16). The efficiency of loan processing is important to firms that may have short-term cash-flow needs, or need to exploit opportunities with limited time horizons; longer processing time leads to individual firms being more financially constrained. Longer Figure 6.16: Loan Processing Time processing is also associated with more firms 15 reporting access to finance as a major constraint. Banks’ processing times are usually long in low- income countries because they have fewer 10 Days automated systems to evaluate business applications requiring careful scrutiny, relying instead on more 5 face-to-face screening as well as other relatively labor-intensive evaluation mechanisms. This is 0 particularly the case for loans for start-up businesses. India Bangladesh Pakistan Sri Lanka Source: Getting Finance Indicators, 2008. 98 F. The Institutional Environment for Lending 223. Inadequate regulations regarding risk concentration allows banks to focus lending to large groups at the expense of diversification and outreach to a wider set of borrowers. The current prudential regulation allows single party and single group exposure of banks to be up to 35 and 50 percent of total equity respectively. This allowable concentration of lending is much higher than institutional norms which cap single party and group exposure at 25 percent of capital as the maximum allowable concentration. Moreover, given the prevalent but opaque nature of conglomerates in Pakistan, and the nature of bank lending, the 50 percent concentration to groups is reportedly being used fully by many if not most banks. In other words, reducing the concentration to international norms will not be easy for banks as it requires a combination of capital injection and diversification of lending, both of which are necessary for the increased outreach of commercial banks and are needed to strengthen productivity. 224. With rising financial sector risk, demands for effective supervision by the State Bank of Pakistan (SBP) and Securities and Exchange Commission of Pakistan (SECP) are rising. As SBP is responsible of overseeing banks and SECP is responsible for non-bank financial institutions, the rising complexity of financial institutions and the growing opaqueness in the jurisdiction of supervisory authorities means that regulatory arbitrage is becoming a greater risk. In addition to growing jurisdictional confusion, the demands on the SBP and SECP to intervene in order to protect the public interest are rising faster than the associated powers and capacity of the regulators. In the case of SBP, its power to effectively supervise conglomerates and intervene in problem banks is weak. On the other hand, SECP’s rapidly increasing portfolio risks outstripping its operational and human capacity. In recent years, SECP’s role in supervising the stock market, as well as the insurance and pension industries, has demonstrated a need for strengthened independence and technical capacity. 225. The lack of clear jurisdictional lines for certain types of non-bank institutions creates possibilities of regulatory arbitrage. There is a need for better supervision capabilities for large conglomerate groups whereby banking and non-bank regulators need strengthened legal powers to intervene and stronger institutional independence to do so, particularly in these cases. While the regulators have tried to fill the gaps on their own in the form of Memorandum of Understanding in March 2009 and establish a joint task force to minimize the risk of contagion and regulatory arbitrage. However, in the near term, there is a need to reform the banking laws to clarify these jurisdictional lines such that institutional strengthening can be designed along clear lines or responsibility. Progress in this institutional dimension of the financial sector oversight would seem to be a pre-requisite to further privatization of the insurance and pension system which would be the next phase of financial sector deepening to consider for Pakistan’s policy makers. 226. Strong creditors’ rights, a functioning credit information system, and well-defined property rights mean more finance for entrepreneurs. Financial depth, outreach, loan features, and exclusion are influenced by the underlying institutional environment governing credit markets. Empirical evidence has strongly linked both depth and access to the strength and transparency of property rights (including creditors’ rights), as well as the system of credit information. The degree to which creditors can credibly enforce contracts and the availability of information on current and prospective borrowers both play important roles in reducing credit risks for banks. Better legal protections enable lenders to offer entrepreneurs money at better 99 terms, and creditors’ rights are associated with higher ratios of private credit to GDP. Clear property and titling systems mean that collateral pledged by firms is more credible to banks. 227. Legal protection for creditors is associated with higher share of bank borrowing in firms’ financing structure and increased access to commercial bank lending by a wider range of firms. Collateralized, or secured, loans are the most common lending contract in the formal financial sector. In developing and industrial countries alike, systems of secured transactions—that is, transactions in which the parties agree to secure an obligation with an enforceable security interest in property—are associated with longer-term lending and lower interest rates as loan contracts can be more easily enforced.71 Besides a lender, the party accepting the security of collateral could be a business selling goods on credit or any other party needing a guarantee—such as a government contracting agency seeking a performance bond from a road construction firm. 228. Firm level data from around the world highlights the mismatch between the assets that firms hold and the assets that most banks accept as collateral. The value of movable property generally makes up three-quarters of banks’ total asset portfolios yet, on average, banks predominantly accept only land and buildings as their main form of collateral (Figure 6.17).72 Creditor laws, if formulated and implemented correctly, expand credit to the private sector by broadening the range of assets acceptable as collateral to banks to include equipment, accounts receivable, and/or inventory. Figure 6.17: Mismatch Between Firm Assets and Collateral Requirements By composition of assets held by firm By composition of assets banks accept as collateral Land and Buildings Machinery Machinery Accounts Receivable Land and Accounts Buildings Receivable Source: World Bank Group Enterprise Surveys, average from 60 countries, 2001-2005. 229. In a key measure reflecting the strength of legal rights, Pakistan ranks favorably compared to some countries in South Asia, but lags behind Bangladesh and India. The Doing Business Legal Rights Index measures the legal rights of borrowers and lenders, and describes how well collateral and bankruptcy laws facilitate lending (Figure 6.18). However, the index does not cover all four pillars of a movable collateral regime—creation, priority, publicity, and enforcement— each of which have weaknesses in Pakistan, leading to restricted access to secured credit to corporate borrowers.73 First, the general description of debts and obligations is not permitted in collateral 71 See Djankov et al (2007); Qian and Strahan (2005); Jappelli and Pagano (2002), and; La Porta and others (1997). 72 The State Bank of Pakistan reports that data on classification of advances by securities pledged for the banking system of Pakistan indicate that 30-35 percent of bank loans are collateralized by real estate and fixed assets. 73 Creation is the process by which a security interest is valid and enforceable. Priority determines who has priority in receiving the proceeds from sale of the collateral and what rights other parties have in the property offered as collateral. Publicity is the manner in which security interests are made public, while enforcement addresses how the property is repossessed in the event of default. 100 agreements in Pakistan, which raises barriers to the Figure 6.18: Doing Business Legal Rights Index finance of inventories and accounts receivable and 10 causes prohibitively high costs of creating a security interest since movable property is difficult 8 to identify with precision. Second, the system of filing or registration of a notice of security interest 6 to publicly establish priority is largely manual and 4 human resource intensive, taking about seven days and forgoing the possibility of creditors 2 electronically searching a computerized database. Third, the basic rules and system for establishing a 0 priority or ranking among those who might have claim against the collateral, is unclear (Table 6.2). Source: Doing Business, 2010. Table 6.2: Composition of Legal Rights Index for Pakistan Can any business use movable assets as collateral while keeping possession of the assets; and can any Yes financial institution accept such assets as collateral? Does the law allow businesses to grant a non possessory security right in a single category of revolving Yes movable assets, without requiring a specific description of the secured assets? Does the law allow businesses to grant a non possessory security right in substantially all of its assets, Yes without requiring a specific description of the secured assets? May a security right extend to future or after-acquired assets, and may it extend automatically to the Yes products, proceeds or replacements of the original assets? Is a general description of debts and obligations permitted in collateral agreements, so that all types No of obligations and debts can be secured by stating a maximum amount rather than a specific amount between the parties? Is there a collateral registry that is unified geographically and by asset type, as well as indexed by the No grantor's name of a security right? Do secured creditors have absolute priority to their collaterals outside bankruptcy procedures? No Do secured creditors have absolute priority to their collaterals in bankruptcy procedures? No During reorganization, are secured creditors' claims exempt from automatic stays on enforcement? Yes Does the law authorize parties to agree on out-of-court enforcements? Yes Source: Doing Business, 2009. 230. Pakistan’s record of contract enforcement is slightly better than countries in South Asia, but much worse than comparators in Asia and Latin America. Strong judicial systems are associated with greater amount of external financing being used by local firms with contract enforcement playing a crucial role. Banks and suppliers tend to restrict lending in response to uncertainty about a lender’s ability to enforce a credit contract in the court. The effect of this perception is strong in Pakistan as banks concentrate lending to large formalized groups, based on ongoing relationships. In Pakistan, 47 procedures are required to enforce a contract―13 more than in Vietnam, 7 more than in Sri Lanka, and 6 more than in Bangladesh. Moreover, while the time taken to enforce a contract in Pakistan is 1.5 times faster than in Bangladesh, it still takes almost 1000 days to enforce a contract in Pakistan, compared to around 300 and 475 respectively in Vietnam and Thailand (Figure 6.19). High costs pose another obstacle to efficient contract enforcement. The cost of enforcing a contract in Pakistan is over 23 percent of the claim, which 101 is 3.4 percent less than the mean for the South Asian region. Conversely, in Thailand and Brazil it costs 14.3 and 16.5 percent of a claim, respectively, to enforce a contract. In Bangladesh, however, the cost can be as high as 63.3 percent of the claim. Figure 6.19: Contract Enforcement By number of procedures to enforce By number of days to enforce 50 1,500 40 1,000 30 20 500 10 0 0 Source: Doing Business, 2010. 231. Credit information sharing improves banks’ knowledge of applicants, permitting more accurate prediction of repayment probability and increasing borrower repayment incentives. Private and public registries play a key role in distributing information on creditworthiness of borrowers and their payment performance, thereby reducing information asymmetries and lowering financial constraints faced by firms and individual borrowers. Empirical evidence links credit information and financial access by showing that credit registries are associated with a higher ratio of private credit to GDP.74 Moreover, as is the case in Pakistan, public credit registries typically distribute positive information and miss some voluntary information which private credit bureaus reflect the fact that banks may only be inclined to share negative information voluntarily. Public and private registries are thus complements, not substitutes.75 232. Pakistan’s credit information index has remained at 4 out of 6 over the past four years, higher than Bangladesh, the same as India and one point less than Sri Lanka. Data on firms and individuals is distributed by private credit bureaus as well the public credit registry. While both positive and negative data is distributed by the private credit bureau, only negative information is dispensed by the public registry. Neither the private credit bureau nor the public credit registry disseminates credit information from retailers, trade creditors or utility companies. Furthermore, the private credit bureau is the only agency that distributes more than two years of historical credit information. Both the private credit bureau and the public credit registry dispense data on all loans below one percent of income per capita and it is not guaranteed by law that borrowers can inspect their data in the largest credit registry.76 74 Djankov et al (2007); Djankov, McLiesh and Shleifer (2006). 75 Private registries are commonly created by marker players to share information among lenders, while public registries are often administered by central banks to improve bank supervision. 76 Doing Business, 2008. 102 233. Coverage in Pakistan’s credit information has increased in recent years but still remains very low. The number of adults covered by the public registry has increased from 0.2 percent in 2005 to 4.9 percent in 2009, while the number of people covered in the private registry has risen from 0.4 percent to 1.5 percent. However, public registry coverage in Pakistan is about 8 percent as compared with Vietnam, Brazil and Chile which cover 13, 20 and 28 percent of the adult population, respectively. Pakistan’s private registry coverage is also significantly lower than that of Brazil, Chile and Thailand (Figure 6.20). Figure 6.20: Public and Private Bureau Credit Information Coverage Across Countries and Over Time By percent of adults across countries By percent of adults, over time in Pakistan 90 5 80 70 4 Public Private Public Private 60 3 50 40 2 30 20 1 10 0 0 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 2009 Source: Doing Business, 2010. 234. Sound property rights that allow firms and households to acquire property and clear titles, lead to higher levels of economic efficiency, productivity and growth. In the absence of secure property rights, entrepreneurs are likely to forego or limit investment opportunities to fixed assets rather than intangible ones, since it is easier to secure returns from fixed assets. Thus, sound property rights also play a significant role in firms’ asset allocation and consequently growth, particularly of new firms.77 Registering and transferring real property, when property rights are not clearly defined, prevents firms from offering as collateral, land, buildings or movable property because of lack of clear titles or a missing system of publicity about liens against their property. At the same time, title transfer can be a complex process ranging from document collection and preparation to due diligence. 235. The process of registering property in Pakistan is officially better than it is in other South Asian countries, but still takes longer than in good practice countries. Like India, it takes six procedures and around 50 days to register property in Pakistan. In Bangladesh, property registration process requires eight procedures and 245 days (Figure 6.21). However, in Thailand, Greece and Chile, the property registration process can be finished in 2, 22 and 31 days respectively. In Pakistan, Execution and registration of deeds before the registration authorities can take up to 38 days. The cost of registering property in Pakistan is about six percent of the total value of the property, compared to eight percent in Bangladesh and India and 4 percent in Sri Lanka. Yet, the average cost to register property for all the South Asian countries is 4.8 percent of the value of property. 77 Claessens and Leaven, 2002. 103 Figure 6.21: Time and Cost of Registering Property By time, number of days By cost, percent of property value 250 10 200 8 150 6 100 4 50 2 0 0 Source: Doing Business, 2010. 236. Small firms are more likely to fail at acquiring new land or buildings compared to large and medium firms. Difficulties in acquiring property and securing titles and construction permits means that firms are less competitive and less able to expand production and Figure 6.22: Acquisition of New land or Buildings employment. This can contribute to financing 100 Attempted to Acquire/Acquired gaps because not only do firms have lower asset 80 values that can be used to secure loan contracts, but also because firms are less productive, Percentage 60 rendering them less credit-worthy. For instance, out of about 60 percent of small firms that tried 40 to acquire new assets in 2006, only 20 percent 20 successfully completed the acquisitions. In the case of large firms, over 73 percent successfully 0 acquired new assets compared to only 13 Large Medium Small percent that failed to do so (Figure 6.22). Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 237. Based on survey responses, existing firms did not appear to have a problem in obtaining clear titles over property; however, this may be reflective of a bias in selecting successful firms. Over 95 percent of all Pakistani firms surveyed said they had clear titles for their land. However, access to land markets and the use of land as loan collateral was fraught with difficulties. Though Doing Business indicators show the time and cost dimensions of the property registration processes in Pakistan to be around the global average and less than the regional average,78 these figures fail to capture the considerable uncertainty involved in obtaining, leveraging and developing land. 238. The process of obtaining titles appears to be grounded in informal payments, particularly for small Pakistani firms. All firms, across size, are expected to make gifts and/or informal payments to obtain titles. For the medium firms, gifts and/or informal payments are anticipated in about 17 percent of the cases. Also, bribes are often expected from firms that are applying for construction-related permits. From small firms, informal gifts/payments are 78 The average for South Asian countries is 6 steps, 56 days and a cost of 6 percent of property value. 104 anticipated in about 71 percent of cases, compared to 44 percent for medium firms and 48 percent for large firms (Figure 6.23). Figure 6.23: Land Title Ownership and Property Registration Land title ownership Requirement of informal gift 0.96 0.71 Small Small 0.22 0.22 0.98 Medium 0.44 0.17 Medium 0.17 0.97 Large 0.21 0.48 Large 0.21 0.0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 Gift/payment expected for the title Land has a clear title 0.0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 for a land title for a construction-related permit % Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007. 239. Land market issues are complex involving a multitude of public agencies at the federal, provincial and state level which own, manage, tax, and regulate commercial land. In addition, most land is held by the public sector. For transactions which do occur in the private sector, the inherent weaknesses in the system of registering prevent certainty of property rights. These weaknesses include: the multiple agencies involved in land registration, complex and opaque record-keeping, and sales transactions taking place without valid conveyance documents. The legal inadequacies and procedural deficiencies prevent indisputable land titles and are one of the primary causes of the case backlog in the courts. Moreover, without clear property rights or original sale deeds, lenders will not consider property as collateral or loan security. The resulting ‘dead capital’ hinders leveraged investment, firm level entry and efficient resource allocation. 240. The federal and provincial governments have countered issues of access to land and site development by making plots on government-owned land in industrial estates available to firms. A survey of the 35 principal industrial estates across the country revealed a stock of more than 17,000 plots, two-thirds of which had been allotted. The survey also revealed the low occupancy rate for most estates, apart from 100 percent occupancy in Sindh Industrial Town and Estate (SITE) in Sindh, and Raiwind and Kot Lakhpat in Punjab. The reasons for the mixed success of industrial estates in Pakistan are said to be: (i) inappropriate selection of location, (ii) poor quality of infrastructure and support services, (iii) insufficient land in prime business locations, (iv) rigid government rules regarding eligibility of investment, and (v) inadequate stakeholder participation in estate management. 79 G. The Way Forward 241. Reflecting the shallow and narrow financial market in terms of sources and products, a range of reforms is necessary to increase access to working and investment finance. While three-quarters of banking assets have been privatized, the limited depth and outreach of the financial sector reflects the weak institutional environment and financial 79 Ministry of Industry, Production and Special Initiatives, A Prosperous Pakistan, 2005 105 infrastructure for lending in Pakistan. As a result, firms rely on internal funds for finance, in lieu of bank credit and other financial products such as trade credit and leasing. 242. Prudential regulations, particularly those on single party and single group exposure, should be amended to be consistent with international norms. As the central bank is increasing the capital requirements, there is opportunity to unwind the concentrated positions of banks in a gradual manner. However, an early signal that banks will need to diversity lending for safety and soundness reasons will provide the needed push for banks to seek out a new client base. 243. Jurisdictional clarity for bank and non-bank regulators needs attention, as does the capacity for all to better supervise banks and non-banks, as a prerequisite to deeper markets. Revisions to the legal and regulatory framework for prudential oversight are urgently needed to: (i) enable better supervision of conglomerates and subsidiaries, (ii) facilitate intervention and corrective action in the case of problem banks, (iii) strengthen independence, particularly for SECP, and (iv) clarify jurisdictional uncertainties for non-bank deposit taking institutions. At the same time, strengthened capacity is needed in both regulators to take on the more complex areas of risk currently emerging in Pakistan. In the near term, clear banking and non-banking laws are needed so institutional strengthening can be designed. Progress in this may be a pre-requisite for privatization of the insurance and pension system as the next phase of financial sector deepening. 244. Strengthening property rights, particularly in registering property and the acquisition of construction permits, would mean enterprises can increase productivity and employment. As a first step, empowering a centralized land registry system at the provincial level to determine titles would go far in this regard. For example, the provincial Excise and Taxation Department has the most complete and accurate record for urban properties in the province and is best suited to carry out this function. Moreover, a system of compulsory registration of all property-related documents that includes deeds, sale agreements, gifts, and powers of attorney can provide the platform on which a system of registering titles can be built. Related to this would be legal action that declares ‘benaami’ transactions unlawful and non-binding. 245. Reconciliation and strengthening of the supervisory role of the SBP and the SECP is needed to ensure the sector’s safety and soundness. Clarity is needed regarding supervisory jurisdiction over non-bank financial institutions, to avoid regulatory arbitrage and support development of the sector. Secondly, SBP’s powers need to be strengthened particularly in the area of consolidated supervision of conglomerates, groups and otherwise, connected companies. 246. Reforming collateral systems would allow firms of all sizes to better exploit their productive assets to secure credit. In addition, it would likely foster intra-firm credit, as enterprises could make loans against receivables and inventories. To do so, a new comprehensive secured transaction law governing creation, priority, publicity, and enforcement of security interests in movable property is needed to address impediments and amend conflicting current laws. 247. A national internet-based filing archive of security interests in movable collaterals should be established, which would replace the current registry system. The new system would separate title registration from filing notice of security interests, and could be operated either by the Government or by private operators. However, developing a filing archive for security 106 interests (commonly referred to as a registry for movable property) will not improve the collateral problems without the accompanying legal reforms described above. 248. Strengthening the enforcement of contracts is paramount to increasing financial access―by fostering arms-length transactions between firms and between lenders and firms. As a backing to the system of secured transactions, the legal and judicial process for enforcing loan contracts should be strengthened. It should include revamping of the system of banking courts to facilitate accelerated pace of loan recovery. Such reorientation would require training of judicial officers in the new secured transaction system and increasing logistical support to help in the disposal of the case backlog. 249. The expansion of credit information can have an important stimulating effect on credit, particularly for borrowers currently excluded from the system. Consideration should be given to integrate the credit information from the public credit bureau into the private credit bureau. This would need to be complemented with a program to strengthen consumer protection to ensure some basic rights, such as the right to receive a copy of credit files for a reasonable fee. A non-judicial dispute resolution mechanism should also be established. 250. Efforts to expand the range of financial products available to firms would do much towards alleviating financing constraints, particularly towards helping firms meet working capital requirements. Providing broad support to the leasing and trade finance industry in Pakistan would increase the availability of finance to firms that are not able to provide their banks with immovable collaterals. Technical assistance, focusing on addressing constraints to the leasing industry through policy and regulatory work, advocacy and awareness-raising, and capacity building to commercial and retail banks to set up leasing operations, is recommended. 251. Finally, access by corporate to access non-bank sources of finance requires long term capacity and policy efforts. In particular, areas being considered are aimed at (i) deepening government bond markets, (ii) rationalizing provincial and federal taxation on financial instruments, (iii) addressing distortions in the National Saving Scheme, and (iv) strengthening private and public credit rating through improved corporate transparency. Improving outreach to individuals would eventually have a multiplier effect on enterprise finance as access to financial services would smooth consumption and accumulate savings. 107 VII. ABSORBING TECHNOLOGY AND FOSTERING CORPORATE INNOVATION A. Technology and Global Competitiveness 252. The technology intensity of products and services today has increased significantly, making technology a key factor of competitiveness in the global economic environment. Technology has created a process of dynamic competitiveness whereby the changing economic landscape is influenced less by endowments and resources, and more from shrinking economic distances and progress in information processing. Increased competition, shortened product life cycles and the heightened role of differentiated products have resulted in the need for higher rates of technology absorption and faster innovation – both at the product as well as at the process level as access to global value chains calls for new organizational methods and product development processes. New products and rising firm-level productivity now requires firms to adopt existing technologies or create new ones to adapt to changing business environment and requires firms have access to skills, improved infrastructure and innovative production systems. 253. A dynamic and competitive environment is Figure 7.1: Technology Readiness Component of an essential element of a market which encourages Global Competitiveness Index upgrading of technology and improvement in quality. Competition encourages firms to constantly 120 innovate and upgrade their products and processes to 100 remain competitive in the market. Pakistan ranks 80 92nd in the competitive index out of 131 countries 60 included in the Global Competitive index and in 40 terms of technological readiness and innovation, 20 0 Pakistan’s ranks low compared to other comparator Brazil India Indonesia Pakistan Bangladesh countries (Figure 7.1). Source: Global Competitiveness Report, WEF, 2008. 254. In Pakistan, the positive impact of improved technology on productivity is coming through large market share firms. The breakdown of the estimates of the IC’s contribution to aggregate and average productivity presented in Chapter 1, shows that the significant variables affecting technology absorption and innovation include: process innovation, new equipment and foreign direct investment (FDI). Moreover, these innovation variables account for almost a fifth of the IC effects at the aggregate level but only 6 percent of the impact on the average productivity of the Pakistani firm (Figure 7.2). The distinction between average and aggregate Figure 7.2: The Contribution of Innovation Variables to Productivity and Employment By average productivity By aggregate productivity By average employment Dummy for Dummy for process innovation process innovation New equipment New equipment TFP Dummy for quality certification Dummy for Dummy for FDI Wage Computer controlled FDI machinery Staff with computer Other IC Dummy for e-mail Other IC Other IC variables variables Exporting experience Dummy for more than 5 competitors Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007.  108 productivity, for all three technology variables, underscores our conclusion that the impact of the technology variables on productivity in Pakistan is coming through the large market share firms. 255. Technological advancement is critical for maintaining competitive advantage in traditional sectors and for attaining greater competitiveness in a fast-changing world economy. Pakistan’s competitive edge is concentrated in a few products such as textiles. The contribution of the textile sector to total exports, employment, foreign exchange earnings, investment and value added makes it the single largest manufacturing sector of Pakistan. It employs close to 40 percent of the total manufacturing labor force, and has been contributing around 60 percent to total merchandise exports. Its competitors such as Turkey, Indonesia and Korea have invested heavily in the latest water jet weaving technology which has helped them capture and sustain the market share in the global exports. 256. The positive impact of competitive pressures on innovation, technology absorption and productivity has been studied quite extensively. Using a dataset from a survey of nearly 4,000 firms in 24 transition countries (BEEP Surveys), “find evidence of the importance of a minimum of rivalry in both absorption and growth: the presence of at least a few competitors is effective both directly and through improving the efficiency with which the rents from market power in product markets are utilized to undertake innovation.�80 The World Bank Russia ICA also finds a positive and significant association between firms that face competitive pressure and those that invest in R&D to undertake innovative activity. 257. However, in Pakistan, domestic competition cannot be seen to have been associated with higher innovation. Most of the firms surveyed (77 percent) suggested that they faced intense domestic competition but the majority (70 percent) of these were small firms. It was interesting to note that while foreign competition did not have significant externalities, in terms of possibly being associated with a larger degree of innovation and technology absorption, domestic competition did show these associations. Of the 6 percent of total firms that introduced new products in the last 3 years, 5 percent faced intense domestic competition. A similar association was found among firms that introduced new processes. 258. Innovation as defined here is a complex process involving the creation, absorption, adaptation and/or application of new ideas by risk-taking firms for commercial purposes. It can originate from sources at home or abroad―through research and development, by firms, applied research, military, and/or academia. For countries at Pakistan’s early stage of technological development, opportunities abound for the absorption of existing and proven technologies through foreign sources―such as FDI, professional and technical services from abroad, imports of capital goods, licensing of products, and even exporting. The challenge is to foster an investment climate which not only attracts these knowledge flows but also encourages firms to react quickly by capitalizing on their commercial application. 259. On the institutional front, the innovation system is led by the Ministry of Science and Technology (MoST), in conjunction with the HEC and the Ministry of Information Technology and Telecommunications (IT&T). Further, the Pakistan Council for Science and Technology (PCST) advises the Government on various science and technology policies and plans, suggesting measures to develop and encourage the application of research and development. The PCST conducts reviews of 80 Carlin, Schaffer, and Seabright (2004, p. 20), 109 the various science and technology and R&D organizations, and provides inputs to the National Commission for Science and Technology (NCST) which is headed by the Prime Minister of Pakistan. 260. The number of firms innovating by introducing Figure 7.3: Share of Firms that new products or upgrading existing product lines is low Introduced New Technologies in the with most activity concentrated in large firms and in the Last Three Years province of Sindh. Only six percent of Pakistani Introduced a new technology (process) manufacturing firms had introduced new or significantly Pakistan improved products in the past three years, as compared to Egypt Chile, the most innovative country in the sample where 70 percent of the firms are innovating (Figure 7.3). India Innovative activity in Pakistan is concentrated in Sindh Turkey where 83 percent of the innovating firms are located. Phillipines Further, 66 percent of these firms employ skilled Vietnam managerial staff, underscoring the importance of human resources in innovative activity. Smaller firms in Pakistan Thailand are less innovative than large and medium size firms South Africa (Table 7.1), despite the fact that the survival of small Brazil firms depends on their building niche markets by 0% 20% 40% 60% 80% developing new and/or improved products. Introduced a new product B. Technology Absorption in Pakistan Pakistan Egypt 261. Technology affects firms’ Srilanka competitiveness―through their ability to research and Turkey develop innovations and to implement these innovations India with the available worker skills. A major element of Bangladesh Pakistan’s vision and long-term strategy for business is to Vietnam see firms adopt technology to facilitate the diversification Phillipines of the economy and raise the returns to investment in Thailand human capital. Improving firm competitiveness in the South Africa global market to a large extent depends on their ability to Brazil adopt new technologies to address the changing business Chile environment. Purchase of new hard and soft technologies 0% 20% 40% 60% 80% is the most straightforward channel for technology Source: Investment Climate Survey, 2007 and World Bank adoption. Enterprise Surveys. Note: 2006 data used for Pakistan, various ICS data used for all other countries. 262. In this context, one needs to distinguish between two methods of innovation—between ideas that are ‘new- Table 7.1: Innovative Activity by Firm to-the-world’ and ideas that are ‘new-to-the-firm.’ New Size Small Medium Large ideas themselves may take any number of Product 5% 17% 22% forms―including new products and processes, new Process 5% 17% 35% organizational techniques, new markets, and new sources Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. of supply.81 Innovation, the exploitation of new ideas, 81 Frenz, M. and Oughton, C. (2005), ‘Innovation in the UK Regions and Devolved Administrations: A Review of the Literature.’ 110 allows for improvements in products and processes and leads to the efficient working of the economy. It is important to distinguish between input and output measures of innovation. Private sector enterprise research and development, gross expenditure on research and development, and industry-science agreements are all measures of inputs to the innovation process. The introduction of new or significantly improved products is a measure of the output from the innovation process. Patents are often considered a proxy for cutting-edge (‘new-to-the-world’) innovation. 263. For the most part, firms in Pakistan acquire technology through imported and domestic purchases of machinery and Table 7.2: Means of Acquiring New Technology equipment, and by employing key Embodied in new machinery or equipment―foreign 51.65 domestic personnel. The majority of firms (78 percent) finance new technology with Embodied in new machinery or equipment―domestic 17.03 internal funds and 21 percent of them use By hiring key personnel―domestic 13.19 bank loans to do so. Retained earnings are Developed or adapted within the establishment locally 5.49 the most important source of internally By hiring key personnel―foreign 3.85 financing new technology. Among the Developed w/equipment supplier―domestic 2.75 various means of acquiring new Transferred from parent company―foreign 1.65 technology (Table 7.2), the most dominant is the purchase of new machinery and Other―domestic 1.65 equipment, particularly from abroad (52 Other―foreign 1.10 percent), emphasizing the role of trade and Developed w/equipment supplier―foreign 1.10 FDI as foreign sources of innovation and Licensing or turnkey operations from abroad 0.55 technology absorption. Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 264. Information and Communication Technology plays an important role facilitating innovation and technology absorption. Information and communication technologies allow for faster and more efficient use of human and physical capital and increase the probability that firms innovate. Besides innovation, the use of ICT also gives firms new opportunities for trade and diversification. The National IT Policy of 2000 states that physical infrastructure and technical skills are prerequisites for ICT development in the country. The policy outlines strategies for creating this technology enabling environment, including a focus on human resource development in the local IT industry through the establishment of four new IT universities; infrastructure development, including the development of incubators and industrial parks; software and hardware development; and legislation that promotes IT usage. However, the IT Policy needs updating and requires integration to explore synergies with the Telecommunications Policy to have a true ICT Policy. As well, it then needs development into an Action plan to have its implementation started, funded and monitored. 265. Advances in the deregulation of the telecommunication industry has gone far to boost technology absorption in Pakistan. The telecom infrastructure in Pakistan is being modernized to offer broadband access as the primary source of internet access to universities, banks and other financial institutions to create an investor-friendly environment. However, the majority of PC- internet connections (97 percent) use dial-up (Figure 7.4). Broadband access is still very low in Pakistan as compared to other countries. Another current and major obstacle facing the ICT sector in the country is the inadequate supply of low cost electrical power. The plan recommended that the Government invest in various fiscal incentives to promote the use of IT in industry and progressively deregulate the telecom industry for telecom services to become affordable and competitively priced. 111 The latter part was successfully achieved in 2004 and has Figure 7.4: Total Fixed Broadband led to a surge in mobile phone access among consumers. Internet Subscribers, 2006 and 2007 The IT and Telecom Division was created in 2000 to act Per 100 inhabitants as the coordinating and apex body for the implementation Pakistan of the IT policy under the purview of MoST. India 266. The ICS analysis shows that firms in Pakistan Sri Lanka 2007 have not as yet fully embraced ICT use in their daily Egypt 2006 business activities. For present day firms, ICT use can Viet Nam have a significant positive impact on production costs and time. Internet and web use can provide access to Brazil potentially larger markets for various enterprises, besides Malaysia reducing transaction costs to a great extent. However, only Turkey 26 percent of manufacturing firms sampled in Pakistan Chile used email regularly to correspond with suppliers and clients. Pakistan lags far behind countries like South 0.0 2.0 4.0 6.0 8.0 Source: International Telecommunication Union, 2008. Africa and Chile where as many as 98 and 92 percent of the firms respectively use email for daily business correspondence (Figure 7.5). Websites are another popular means of business communication in most developed countries. Here again, Pakistan trails behind with only 18 percent of firms using their websites to communicate with suppliers and clients, as compared to South Africa and Chile where 71 and 68 percent of the firms respectively use websites as the main source of business communication. Figure 7.5: Electronic Ways to Communicate with Customers and Suppliers By share of firms that use email regularly By share of firms that use their own website Pakistan Egypt Pakistan Phillipines Egypt Bangladesh Brazil India Bangladesh Vietnam Vietnam Srilanka Srilanka Thailand India Brazil Thailand Turkey Turkey Chile Chile South Africa South Africa 0% 20% 40% 60% 80% 100% 0% 20% 40% 60% 80% Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007 and World Bank Enterprise Surveys. Table 7.3: Reasons for Firms not using Either Email or 112 267. Besides inadequate power supply Own Website for Business Correspondence in Pakistan and broadband access, lack of worker skills Lack of skilled or experienced staff 29.1% has played a vital role in determining the Other Reasons 19.1% low degree of technology adoption by Cost of software/hardware and maintenance 1.67% Pakistani firms. The IC survey asked firms Unavailability of internet connection 1.48% to state reasons for not using either email or Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. websites for business communication. The most important reason given by firms was that none of their clients and/or suppliers used the internet. The second most important reason given was that they lacked skilled and experienced staff that could use the internet (Table 7.3). C. Own Resources for Innovation and Technology 268. Studies show that technological change and innovation, when driven by research and development, are important sources of productivity growth and increased welfare. Research suggests, suggest that there is a high correlation between those countries that have shown significant economic improvement and countries that have made substantial investment in R&D.82 There are various sources of technological adoption and innovation. These include domestic sources such as R&D expenditure, having or acquiring a skilled and trained labor force, and adopting technology from abroad through trade, FDI and licensing. 269. R&D investments are important for both innovation and technology absorption. While R&D is a basic input for innovation, since it potentially leads to the introduction of new and/or improved products, it is also vital to developing the technological absorptive capacities in firms. 83 From 2000 to 2005, R&D investment in Pakistan increased from 0.13 percent of GDP to 0.44 percent. While this shows a steady increase in R&D investment, it is still lower than in most comparator countries (Figure 7.6) with the exception of Thailand and Sri Lanka. Pakistan’s low patenting performance can be attributed to a large extent to its low level of R&D investments. Countries typically invest more in R&D Figure 7.6: R&D Expenditure as a Percentage of GDP, 2005 as they develop their industrial base since the opportunity costs of investing in R&D 100% become lower and their private returns 80% become higher. Many highly-innovative Percentage 60% countries like Israel and Finland invested 40% more in R&D than other countries with 20% similar (low) income levels as them, 0% especially during the early stages when South Africa Brazil Turkey India Chile Pakistan Thailand Sri Lanka they were catching up with more Source: World Development Indicators, 2008. technologically advanced countries. 270. In Pakistan, the Government has been the main investor in R&D. While both public and private R&D expenditure are complementary, private sector R&D investments are likely to lead to more commercially viable innovations because the latter will only invest in R&D to respond to 82 Systems of Innovation: Growth, Competitiveness and Employment, Charles Edquist and Maureen McKelvey, June 2000. 83 Cohen and Levinthal, 1990. 113 market incentives. Until 2003, 100 percent of R&D Figure 7.7: R&D Expenditure in Pakistan expenditure in Pakistan was by the Government. Higher education (UNESCO, 2008). In 2005, this share declined to 87 Not distributed percent. However, there is currently no business Abroad expenditure on R&D in Pakistan (Figure 7.7). The contrast is striking when compared with innovative economies like Finland where close to 70 percent of R&D expenditure is from the business sector. Pakistan Government clearly lags behind the other comparator countries in the sample, all of which show higher levels of R&D expenditure by business: Malaysia (71 percent), Turkey and Chile (46 percent each), South Africa (44 percent), Source: UNESCO database, 2008. Brazil (39 percent), and India (20 percent). 271. Patents granted by the United States Patent and Trademark Office (USPTO) to firms, are useful standardized indicators reflecting the production of globally applicable innovation. Having access to and using a legal framework for the protection of intellectual property rights is an important element of the investment climate. Pakistani firms do not apply for patent protection in the US. The low demand for patent protection in Pakistan stems not only from the industrial structure being dominated by small firms making low-technology traditional products, but also from the fact that local patenting is more relevant to Pakistani inventors than patents granted by the USPTO (Figure 7.8). Figure 7.8: Patents Granted by the USPTO 3.5 Patents Granted by USPTO pe 3 million inhabitants 2.5 2 1.5 1 0.5 0 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 Year Brazil Chile Egypt, Arab Rep. India Malaysia Pakistan South Africa Sri Lanka Thailand Turkey Source: USPTO; World Bank WDI database, 2008. 272. Skilled workers, science and technology personnel and researchers, to a large extent, define the absorptive capacity of a country. At present, in Pakistan, technical education is being imparted by 57 technical colleges and over 700 vocational technical institutions. However, unfortunately, most of these institutes teach little that is relevant for the industry (Vision 2030 document). The Government acknowledges that the number of inadequately trained graduates is low due to the lack of linkages between education and industry and poorly trained teachers drawing low salaries. 114 273. Further, Pakistan dedicates a low share of researchers to R&D. In this respect, it lags behind all the other comparator countries, with only 80 researchers in R&D per million people, as compared to 833 researchers per million in Chile and 536 researchers per million in Turkey (Figure 7.9). With a view to increasing technical and skilled manpower, the ministry has introduced scholarship programs to train teachers and researchers overseas in the fields of industrial electronics, engineering, precision mechanics, and Figure 7.9: Researchers in R&D, 2005 CAD/CAM technology. The key to making the transition from a low-tech 900 800 economy dominated by traditional industry Per million people 700 to a high-tech, innovative country lies in 600 500 increasing the educational attainments of 400 the workforce. The private sector would 300 200 also be required to invest in training and 100 upgrading the skills of its employees in 0 Chile Turkey Malaysia Brazil South Thailand Sri Lanka Pakistan order to remain competitive in this Africa dynamic environment. Source: UNESCO database, 2008. 274. Amongst provinces, Punjab stands out in recognizing the need for more industry- relevant education and experience among graduates. The Government of Punjab has established a Technical Education and Vocational Training Authority (TEVTA). However, technical institutions are still not equipped with up-to-date training materials and equipment, requiring investments in these universities and technical training institutes. D. Technology Sources from Trade, FDI and Licensing 275. Empirical multi-country studies show that international trade mediates flows of knowledge, allowing firms and industries to acquire technology that expands their productive capabilities. This often occurs in ways that show up in conventional productivity measures. Trading with countries that export more advanced technology goods usually facilitates the acquisition of new technical competencies on the part of importers. By purchasing imported inputs and capital goods, firms in less developed countries acquire use of the technology embodied in these goods, a process referred to as technology transfer. Trade, FDI, licensing, and standards represent four important channels of adoption of technology from abroad. As a technological follower, Pakistani firms should seek to acquire foreign technology through these sources of technology adoption. 276. Trade openness exposes local firms to global best practices technology and management techniques, and also increases the competitive pressure on them. Adopting technologies from abroad and adapting them to local needs is also less costly, less risky and quicker than developing entirely new technologies domestically. Facing competition from foreign firms, which are often more efficient in production and offer higher quality products than many domestic incumbents, increases the competitive pressure on local industries. This increased pressure, in turn, implies that domestic firms make greater efforts to improve productive efficiency and alter their product mix so as to better compete with the new entrants. The significant, positive impact of openness to international trade on conventionally measured productivity growth, as found in the aggregate country-level studies mentioned above, has been confirmed at the firm level in ECA (Europe and Central Asian) countries.84 84 Branstetter, Goldberg and Kuriakose, in ‘Globalization and Technology Absorption in Europe and Central Asia’, 2008. 115 277. The purchase of foreign capital goods is a major source of acquisition of newer, more effective technologies. Trading with countries that are able to export advanced technology goods can facilitate the acquisition of new technical competencies on the part of importers. By purchasing imported inputs and capital goods, firms in less developed countries acquire the use of the technologies embodied in these goods. Conversely, one may posit that participation in export markets enables firms to become more productive, a phenomenon referred to as “learning through exporting, �85 278. The impact of trade liberalization on Pakistan’s exports has been positive but limited. Pakistan’s exports are concentrated in the low technology garments sector; this is reflected in the fact that the largest share of manufactured exports comprises low technology textile products. As of 2007, approximately 58 percent of Pakistan’s US$ 17.1 billion exports could be attributed to textiles and textile products. Four of the top five exports from Pakistan are textiles and apparel clothing products. Agricultural products such as rice, fruits and vegetables constitute the second largest segment of exports, accounting for approximately 11 percent of exports. The remaining exports are fragmented across a broad range of products including petroleum, chemicals and machinery. Pakistan’s competitive edge is concentrated in a few products which are low-end technology products. The trade policy for the country needs to aim at diversification of exports, enhancing competitiveness, and stepping up trade facilitation efforts. Box 7.1: Technology in Textiles To a large extent, all segments of the textile sector―from cotton cultivation to manufacturing of garments―lack modern technology. This is important because the contribution of the textile sector to total exports, employment, foreign exchange earnings, investment, and value-added makes it the single largest manufacturing sector in Pakistan. The sector employs close to 40 percent of the total manufacturing labor force and has been contributing between 60-70 percent to total merchandise exports. The major markets for its exports are the US and the UAE. The technology deployed in cotton ginning in Pakistan is outdated and based on local manufacturing by semi-literate mechanics. The weaving of synthetic fabric is done mostly on low technology power looms that do not have the dexterity for producing high quality fabrics or handling complex processes. Competitors such as Turkey, Indonesia and Korea have invested heavily in the latest water-jet weaving technology, which has helped them capture and sustain market shares in global exports. Modern air-jet and projectile looms are equipped with Computer Aided Manufacturing (CAM) capabilities that enable machines to handle complex fabric construction without compromising quality. Higher quality exports from Pakistan would require better technology and skilled workers who could work these technologies. The country’s apparel sector, on the other hand, has been unable to exploit its potential in the international market due to scarce skills in apparel designing and stitching. a/ Pakistan’s exports of leather to European countries have been declining due to a shift of the tanning industry to China, Korea and other Asian countries. According to official estimates, the cost of production of leather goods is very high in Pakistan (compared to its competitors like China and India), particularly the cost of inputs like utilities and taxes, making the products uncompetitive in the international market. With Pakistan facing increasing competition from technologically more advanced competitors in the textile sector, it is necessary for the country to diversify its exports into other growing sectors. The World Bank (2006)b/ suggests that if the quality of the investment environment in Pakistan were to match that of Shanghai, the average productivity of textile firms in Karachi would improve by 81 percent, the rate of return to capital would increase by 36 percent, and wages would rise by 23 percent. The increased profitability would encourage more investment and further improvements in competitiveness. ___________ a/ Industrial Vision Document. b/ World Bank, Pakistan: Growth and Export Competitiveness, 2006. 85 Ibid. 116 279. High-technology represents an Figure 7.10: Pakistan’s Export Orientation increasing but very low share of Pakistan’s Exports of goods and services as a percentage of GDP total manufacturing exports. The share of high- 18 technology products in Pakistan’s total 16 14 manufacturing exports has been lower than that Percentage 12 of all comparator countries except Egypt 10 8 (Figure 7.10). This share continues to be the 6 smallest, with low technology goods making the 4 2 bulk (more than 75 percent) of the exports, 0 followed by medium technology goods and 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 finally high technology goods. Pakistan’s Source: UN COMTRADE, 2008. imports, however, have a 20 percent component High-tech exports as share of total manufacturing exports involving machinery and equipment, a possible Brazil Chile Egypt, Arab Rep. source of technology transfer. 70 Malaysia Pakistan Philippines Hi Tech Exports as a % of total manufactured South Africa Thailand 60 280. FDI acts as a channel for technology 50 transfer when investors introduce product and 40 process technologies from their home exports countries to their domestic subsidiaries. Not 30 only can a multinational corporation introduce 20 technology within the subsidiary, but spillovers, 10 including backward and forward linkages, also 0 transmit technology to domestically-owned 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 Source: World Development Indicators, 2008. firms. The potential spillover effects of FDI activities would include encouraging a commercial culture among scientists and engineers and firms in the host country, as well as more industry-science collaborations. There is a close connection between FDI and trade. Multinationals have played particularly significant roles in expanding international trade in successful developing countries such as China. Local firms benefit from the international exposure to best practice technologies that come directly or indirectly through the intermediation of foreign firms. 281. Transnational corporations could help countries develop their R&D systems by facilitating access to global supply and distribution chains. What is required in the host country is an ability to absorb these new technologies, adapting them to local conditions and applying them to alternative uses. It is for these reasons that the participation of developing countries in the globalization of R&D has so far been uneven. Some developing countries that have good infrastructure facilities, highly trained workforces, reasonable intellectual property protection, and appealing domestic markets have attracted significant FDI in R&D86 These countries have benefited from the opportunities provided by the increasing demand of multinationals for inexpensive talent and new developing markets. These developing countries have also formulated policies to maximize the degree of technology spillovers from FDI and enhance their absorptive capacity by encouraging local firms to engage in R&D. 282. Net FDI inflows, as a percentage of GDP, to Pakistan have been increasing steadily but are lower than those in other comparator countries There has been a dramatic growth of FDI in Pakistan over the last five years, with a significant growth witnessed in 2006 (Figure 86 Pearce, 1999. 117 7.11). The main drivers have been the telecommunications (mobile phones) sector as well as the financial services sector which accounted for 37 percent and 18 percent of total FDI respectively. According to the State Bank of Pakistan, there also seems to be a fairly high rate of reinvested earnings by these sectors in their companies, indicating long term approaches to market development. The telecommunications sector reinvested more than 27 percent of its earnings and the financial sector reinvested more than 41 percent of its earnings. However, investor confidence needs to be strengthened in the present economic and political scenario. Recent events could hamper the confidence that foreign investors may have developed in Pakistan. Figure 7.11: Foreign Direct Investment as Percent of GDP By percentage of GDP, international comparisons By manufacturing exports yearly flows, 2002-2006 4.00 FDI, Net Inflows as % of GDP 2005-06 FDI, net inflows (% of GDP) 10.0 2005 2006 3.50 9.0 3.00 8.0 7.0 2.50 6.0 2.00 5.0 1.50 4.0 3.0 1.00 2.0 0.50 1.0 0.0 0.00 Egypt, Arab Thailand Vietnam Pakistan India Sri Lanka South 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 Rep. Africa Source: World Development Indicators, 2008. 283. Alliances and joint ventures are another means of transferring technology through FDI, since they involve local partners. The joint ventures that have actually transferred technology or produced new technologies have had both parties gain substantially from the collaborations. Only 0.6 percent of the firms sampled in the Pakistani manufacturing sector had joint ventures with foreign partners. This is the lowest proportion of joint ventures in the countries sampled. India had nearly nine times more foreign joint ventures than Pakistan (Table 7.4). For Pakistan, in particular, collaboration with foreign apparel manufacturers would help bring in new technology and shorten the learning curve for the apparel industry. The country, however, currently faces a major challenge as it is being viewed as a risky destination. There are other IC obstacles as well, such as Pakistani labor legislation that does not allow for flexible hiring and firing, which could influence the decisions of multinational firms to invest in a new destination. Table 7.4: Joint Ventures in Manufacturing Firms: Comparative Analysis Philippines, Thailand, Brazil Pakistan Egypt India South Africa Turkey Share of manufacturing firms which agreed 5.7 2.5 to have joint ventures with foreign partners 4.2 0.6 2.2 8.9 8.7 7.6 in the past three years ( by percent) Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007 and World Bank Enterprise Surveys. Table 7.5: Use of Foreign Licensed Technologies Small Medium Large Using foreign technology license 1% 12% 17% Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 118 284. Licensing is the fourth technology Figure 7.12: Licensing for Technology Transfer transfer mechanism but not a very accessible Share of firms using a technology licensed from a one for firms in developing countries, with the foreign-owned company exception of large domestic firms. Smaller firms Pakistan usually do not have the means to identify and India negotiate collaborative agreements with foreign suppliers. In Pakistan, as in other countries, Bangladesh licensing is a more accessible technology transfer Brazil mechanism for large firms (Table 7.5). Only 1 Vietnam percent of small firms use technology licensed Egypt from foreign-owned companies. The total share Chile of firms in Pakistan that use technology licensed Turkey from a foreign-owned company is a mere 3 Philipines percent (Figure 7.12), lowest among the South Africa comparator countries, trailing behind the leader Thailand Thailand (48 percent). Since licensing occurs 0% 20% 40% 60% when a technology is still protected by a patent, Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007 and World Bank licensing is an indication of the use of relatively Enterprise Surveys. advanced technology. However, there are Licensing and royalty payments per capita (USD) limitations to licensing as a mode of technology manufacturing exports transfer. Licensing only embodies the codified Bangladesh Brazil Chile Egypt, Ara part of a technology and may not have the India Malaysia Pakistan Philippines Licensing and Royalty Payments Per desired effect on technological capabilities South Africa Thailand Turkey without a prior accumulation of tacit knowledge 50 by the recipient firm. Receipts from international 40 Capita (USD) licensing agreements are contractual transfers of 30 technology to other countries, and represent a 20 certain measure of the prevalence of innovation 10 in Pakistan, of the country’s ability to 0 commercialize its technology abroad and of the 2000 2001 2002 2003 2004 2005 20 Source: World Development Indicators, 2008. value placed on Pakistani technology in global markets. The receipts in the case of Pakistan are Figure 7.13: Share of Firms That Have Obtained negligible. Licensing and royalty payments from ISO Certification Pakistan are higher, although very low by Pakistan international comparisons (Figure 7.13). Egypt Philipines E. Standards and Quality Certification Bangladesh Brazil 285. The use of standards is an avenue for India technological progress by promoting quality Chile enhancing competition and diffusing technology. Vietnam Standards and a supporting quality infrastructure Thailand also play an important role in trade by providing South Africa information on new products and processes and Turkey facilitating profitable networks by allowing 0% 10% 20% 30% 40% 50% participants to benefit from interacting with each Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007 other. As standards “stipulate what can or cannot 119 be exchanged and define the procedures that must be followed for exchange to take place�87 complying with standards requirements in foreign markets is a critical factor in determining market access. Therefore, standards serve high-quality markets and provide firms an incentive to adopt them in order to gain access to these markets. 286. Pakistani firms are far behind in obtaining quality certification. The share of Pakistani firms that have obtained ISO certifications is a mere 9 percent (Figure 7.13), far behind Turkey where 44 percent of the firms have obtained ISO certifications. The proportion, in Pakistan, is slightly higher in the services sector where 14 percent of the firms in the sample had obtained ISO certification. Small firms are much less likely to obtain ISO certifications in Pakistan with only 3 percent (Table 7.6) of small firms having done so, compared with 34 percent of medium-sized and 71 percent of large firms. Firms need to be encouraged to adopt quality certification in order to adopt new technologies and innovate. Adopting quality standards can Table 7.6: Firms have Obtained an ISO Certification (%) help firms integrate in market segments in Small Medium Large which there is more demand for innovation. Policies to support innovation Obtained Quality Certification 3 34 71 Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. and quality reinforce each other and are complementary. 287. The Ministry of Science and Technology is establishing the National Quality System including an infrastructure of metrology, standards, testing and quality - (MSTQ). In addition, the conformity assessment process requires fulfillment of certain voluntary and mandatory standards. The technology wing in the Ministry of Science and Technology is responsible for the development of the National Quality System, consisting of the following pieces:  The Pakistan Standard and Quality Control Authority (PSQCA), is the national standardization body responsible for development, promotion and conformity assessment of standards which (i) promote industrial efficiency and development, (ii) ensure public health, safety and consumer protection, (iii) facilitates trade and furthers international cooperation. PSQCA has published about 25,000 standards, including 78 items – of which 20 are food – to include as compulsory certification.  The Pakistan National Accreditation Council (PNAC) is responsible for Quality Management System which accredits for ISO-9000 and 14000 (for Environmental Management System), tests, calibrates and accredits medical and non-medical laboratories, and accredits product certification guidelines to international accreditation standards.88 PNAC also conducts training programs on MSTQ  The National Physical and Standards Laboratory (NPSL) in Islamabad maintains national reference standards of measurements and materials in conformity with International Standards and is responsible for their dissemination in the country. In theory, the NPSL is responsible for calibration and should act as “National Metrology 87 Brenton, 2004. 88 PNAC has recently achieved the peer evaluation (MRA) status without any non-conformance which reflects that PNAC has maintained its international status and now PNAC accredited labs are internationally acceptable 120 Institute (NMI), like other countries with a developed quality infrastructure. In the case of Pakistan, the PNAC conducts calibration as well as accreditation.  The National Quality Policy and Plan (NQPP) along a National Quality Award Scheme (NQAS) helps industries to decrease the rate of rejection which currently stands at more than a quarter; The NQAS provides training facilities to private industries to help them improve quality of productivity and efficiency. The NQPP would also encourage organizations to get ISO certification as firms lag in achieving this quality certification. 288. Pakistan has for some time focused on a comprehensive program for strengthening its MSTQ infrastructure and recently has revived earlier efforts. The National Quality Policy & Plan, approved by the Pakistan Cabinet in November, 2004, aimed at strengthening the national quality infrastructure. More recently, MoST has conducted countrywide training programs for auditors and consultants in ISO-9000 and ISO-14000 quality systems. Industries and institutions are being given special incentives to go in for ISO certification. While there are various laboratories that have been set up to provide calibration testing services, for the future, the National Physical Standards laboratory is being upgraded to a National Metrology Center. F. Science-Industry Collaboration 289. The Government’s assessment is that local industry does not benefit from institutional R&D due to the lack of synergies and linkages between industries, R&D and academia.89 Industry-science linkages are one of the important elements of knowledge flows in an economy. Firms stand to gain as they would be able to use the research to innovate in their products and processes, and researchers also get increased access to funds for research activity, laboratories and equipment. Surveying more than 100 academic scientists in the US, Lee (2000) found that the most important reasons for them to collaborate with industry were: (i) to secure funds for research assistants and laboratory equipment; (ii) to gain insights into their own academic research; (iii) to test the application of their theories; and (iv) to supplement funds for their own academic research. 290. In order to encourage industry-science collaboration, there should be incentives for both industry and researchers to collaborate. The incentives for researchers to engage in IP (intellectual property) activities are low in Pakistan. The present legal agreements between the universities and their academic faculties do not facilitate consultations with the business sector and the generation and transfer of IP between the industry and research sectors. Researchers may also find the administrative process of identifying potential matches in the industry and managing these projects time consuming and a waste of their research time. Academics need to be encouraged to consult with industry and the financial benefits resulting from any patents should be split between industry and the academics to incentivize the latter. The Technology Based Industrial Vision and Strategy for Pakistan’s Socio economic Development document suggests the need for programs that facilitate the mobility of scientists and engineers between universities, research institutions and industry. These would require funding schemes that would finance projects jointly submitted by industry and research units. Further, there are proposals that allow R&D institutes to patent their output and charge licensing fees for technology that can be used by industry. MoST plans to set up 89 Government of Pakistan, Medium Term Development Framework for Science and Technology, 2006. 121 special centers for R&D support facilities in the existing industrial estates, with the aim of strengthening linkages between industry, academia and R&D institutions. 291. There is a program in Pakistan that aims at fostering cooperation between academia and industry. HEC-CSF is an applied Research Support Program which is a joint program of the Higher Education Commission (HEC) and Competitiveness Support Fund (CSF). This program focuses on industrial sectors where the country is already a major contributor to world trade, on sectors where there is a high potential for international trade with plenty of competition, and sectors that need development for both local and international consumption. The strategy is aimed at fostering greater autonomy and creativity among researchers, and providing firms with incentives to encourage them to set up in house R&D centers and continuously train their workers with a view to improve the competitiveness of the industrial exports from Pakistan. Results in terms of increased science- industry collaboration however have not been evident in the recent years. 292. Diaspora programs are an effective way of encouraging cooperation between domestic industry and Pakistani researchers and other experts working abroad. The HEC has initiated various programs to encourage researchers to return to Pakistan or collaborate with domestic industry and research institutes. More attention and effort is needed in this regard as the potential is high and the opportunity is available, particularly under the current country circumstances. G. Public Intervention to Encourage Technology-based Entrepreneurship 293. With SMEs playing a large role in the Pakistan economy, there is a specific need for prudent public intervention to overcome market and coordination failures associated with technological progress. The Economic Census of Pakistan in 2005 stated that 99 percent of the business enterprises in Pakistan were SMEs. As these enterprises are an important source of employment, they are often considered a priority in developing countries. The Economic Census suggests that SMEs account for approximately 78 percent of industrial employment and 35 percent of its value-added. Their ability to generate employment and to diversify economic activity can make a significant contribution to trade, exports and employment generation. Recognizing the role that SMEs play in Pakistan, the GoP set up the Small & Medium Enterprise Development Authority (SMEDA) in October 1998. This institution became the focal point for implementing policies formulated to stimulate growth and investment, and providing and facilitating the resource base and business support services for SMEs in Pakistan. 294. Penetration of agency support in Pakistan is low, especially among smaller firms. A number of organizations in Pakistan are working towards bringing the Government and private firms closer to each other through public-private dialogue and agency support. Among others, these organizations include the Federation of Pakistan Chambers of Commerce & Industry (FPCCI), Pakistan Business Council, SMEDA, Export Promotion Board (EPB), and Board of Investment (BoI). The 2006 ICS reveals that the reach of these (and other public agencies)90 is low, with only 7 percent, 11 percent and 8 percent of firms benefiting from programs sponsored by SMEDA, EPB and BoI respectively (Figure 7.14). The outreach is restricted to large firms and firms in Sindh province (almost overwhelmingly in the city of Karachi). Further, among the firms that benefited from one or more public agency, less than 90 Firms were also asked in the 2006 Pakistan ICS if they benefited from any other Government agency. Less than 0.6 percent of the firms in the full sample and 1.4 percent in Karachi answered in the affirmative. 122 1 percent considered the agency to have been supportive of their needs. A careful examination of the functioning of the various agencies is needed to improve their quality of service and outreach. Figure 7.14: Agency Outreach By time By size of firm By province 20 SMEDA EPB BOI 60 30 SMEDA EPB BOI SMEDA EPB BOI 50 25 15 40 20 10 30 15 20 10 5 10 5 0 0 0 2006 2002 Large Medium Small Balochistan NWFP Sindh Punjab Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. 295. The Government has set up the Pakistan Enterprise Competitiveness Support Fund (CSF), with the objective of supporting adoption of innovative strategies and technologies. The Fund has a number of financial instruments―such as equity financing, credit guarantees and matching grants―to enable firms to buy technology. The ADB is financing a Business Development Fund to provide assistance for marketing, training, R&D, and technology acquisition and upgradation. 296. The number of SMEs that have graduated to becoming large firms is negligible.91 The ICS data shows that the mean age of the SME firms is 60 years. This leads us to question the reason for the preponderance of SMEs that are unable to graduate to becoming large firms, a natural course of growth and development. The ADB suggests that credit rationing is a major binding constraint for SME firms in Pakistan and could be a major constraint for their growth. There are both supply and demand side constraints responsible for the credit rationing. Weak and poorly enforced creditor rights due to high per unit costs of SME lending, and low confidence in the credit-worthiness of SMEs lead to the supply side constraints. Long loan disbursement procedures and collateral requirements lead to demand side constraints (ADB, 2005). Other reasons cited are the underdeveloped physical and social infrastructure that the SMEs have to rely on since they do not possess the ability to develop any alternatives, and the low skill base in Pakistan. H. Technology Commercialization and Bridging Institutions 297. Science and technology parks can play a vital role as intermediaries between science and industry. The location of a firm in a science and technology park will accelerate the diffusion of new technologies (Siegel et al. 2003). They argue that the proximity between firms and universities in science and technology parks promotes the natural exchange of ideas through both formal and informal networks. Formal methods include licensing of technologies and informal methods include meetings between academic and industrial personnel, and job mobility of scientists and researchers. The science and technology parks serve a dual role―companies will work with the parks to access university expertise, access IP, and exchange ideas and personnel. The parks act as intermediaries to the universities and as intermediaries to facilitate deals with industry. For the researchers and academics, they provide a space to create spin-off companies, together with the necessary supportive services. Seeing such companies develop is usually the best incentive for other university staff to 91 Unleashing the potential of the SME sector with a focus on Productivity Improvements, Shahab Khawaja 123 create their own businesses. The parks are also meant to play a vital role in IP management and transfer of IP from the university faculties to industry, and commercializing the universities’ IP. 298. The institutions that are considered technology parks92 in Pakistan function more as incubators than science and technology parks, given the services they provide. However, these industrial parks seem to have had a positive Figure 7.15: Proportion of Firms Undertaking influence on firm level innovative activity. Innovative Activity Located in Industrial Parks Among the firms surveyed in the ICS sample, 100% 28 percent were located in industrial parks. A 80% large proportion of the more innovative firms 60% were also located in these industrial parks 40% (Figure 7.15). 20% 0% ISO Technology Website Email New New New 299. In order to build an SME sector with license process product technology Source: Investment Climate Survey 2007. the latest technological developments, the Government is setting up Technology Incubation Centers (TIC). These TICs would act as bridging institutes between science and industry and provide technology transfer services, akin to Technology Transfer Offices in other countries. Other initiatives to facilitate technology transfer and innovation among SMEs include technology parks and hi-tech townships established by the Government. 300. Institutions such as technology transfer units, technology parks and incubators facilitate the commercialization of research. These efforts can provide products and processes that are better suited to local conditions and contribute to training local technical staff. Technology parks can address critical elements of infrastructure, such as reliable uninterrupted power supply and low cost quality office space, which play an important role in the industry. The Pakistan Software Export Board (PSEB) has developed an IT park program which provides land concessions to private contractors to build and operate the IT parks for given periods of time; however the current political turmoil has impeded the progress of this program. 301. The Government has established the Scientific and Technological Development Corporation (STEDEC) to facilitate commercialization of the research undertaken in R&D organizations in Pakistan. This institution provides finances in the form of soft loans, with a comfortably long period of recovery, for the commercialization of projects conducted by R&D organizations. Another such scheme has been launched by MoST, under the name ‘Contractual Research’. It funds private entrepreneurs for initiatives that are innovative and can be successfully commercialized. 302. The lack of availability of early-stage risk capital (or venture capital) is a constraint to nurturing local industry. The main source of financing available is traditional banks that have collateral requirements. This, often, restricts entrepreneurs from borrowing. The National IT 92 The International Association of Science Parks (IASP) defines a ‘science and technology park’ as: “an organization managed by specialized professionals, whose main aim is to increase the wealth of its community by promoting the culture of innovation and the competitiveness of its associated businesses and knowledge- based institutions. To enable these goals to be met, a Science Park stimulates and manages the flow of knowledge and technology amongst universities, R&D institutions, companies and markets; it facilitates the creation and growth of innovation-based companies through incubation and spin-off processes; and provides other value-added services together with high quality space and facilities.� 124 policy does mention the Government’s initiative in setting up a venture capital fund which will be channeled initially into existing IT companies to boost their export marketing capabilities and software development efforts. The CSF is also supporting the Securities & Exchange Commission of Pakistan in its efforts to improve the legal framework surrounding the venture capital industry. Some of the policies that hinder the growth of the venture capital industry in Pakistan (CSF, 2008) include regulations that do not allow insurance companies and pension funds to invest in high risk sectors such as the venture capital industry. Further, the minimum capital requirement to set up a fund management company in Pakistan is US$ 4,200,000, compared to US$ 100,000 internationally. Also, there are no 'business angel' networks that can act as a matching facility for funds and entrepreneurs. I. The Way Forward 303. On the policy front, the Government can play a vital role in creating incentives for firms to invest in more technologies. These initiatives would include creating the necessary physical infrastructure in transportation and communication, building research capacity, raising quality standards for higher education and research institutes, creating stronger intellectual property rights laws and a sound judicial system to enforce them, and promoting an efficient regulatory environment. These policies need to be part of an overarching science and technology policy which gives the economy a clear strategic focus to strengthen the overall incentive regime for firms to conduct innovations. A major challenge for most developing countries today is their inadequate science and technology base which needs to be upgraded to attract private sector R&D, both domestic and foreign. Only long term and strategic technology policies by their governments can help decrease the technology divide that these countries face. The globalized economies today provide further opportunities for developing countries to tap into knowledge networks and specialize in niche areas in the value chain. 304. In general, a conducive investment climate is needed to stimulate innovative activities. The fundamentals which underpin an innovative economy and encourage absorption of technology produced at home or abroad, include a competitive business environment with free entry, flexible and open markets, speedy and orderly exit, robust contract enforcement, sound infrastructure―particularly power and telecommunications, access to finance―particularly risk capital, and an educated and technically competent labor force. For foreign investment though, the primary pre-requisite is a stable macro, political and security environment. More flexible labor legislation that does allows for more flexible hiring and firing, could influence the decisions of multinational firms to invest in Pakistan. 305. A science and technological policy to ensure appropriate institutional infrastructure and financing of innovation activities may be considered. The Government may consider developing an integrated national strategy for research and innovation, developed under the guidance of a consultative council representing Government, research and industry at a high political level. The National IT Policy and Action Plan did propose to seek legislative approval of changes to statutes that would encourage the use of e-commerce which remains very low amongst Pakistani firms. 306. In addition, efforts for narrowing the technology gap require that considerable resources be directed towards infrastructure development and increasing the currently low 125 penetration of the broadband network. Though efforts have to be made to accelerate penetration of broadband internet services, policies to encourage and attract investments in the IT sector have not been able to overcome nationwide investment climate constraints.93 Establishing IT hubs (IT economic zones) in major cities to mitigate investment climate constraints in limited contained areas could help encourage further investments from both domestic and foreign investors and increase the penetration of broadband networks. 307. While the regulatory framework for electronic data protection, intellectual property rights (IPR) and cyber crimes exists in Pakistan, enforcement needs strengthening. Corporate surveys indicate that the protection of IPR is usually mentioned by multinational companies as among the top criteria in taking an R&D investment decision abroad. Pakistan may be able to establish a niche in the global market through stronger enforcement of IPR than other regional countries. 308. The major challenge to raise technical skills should be addressed through directed programs at Diaspora and investments in polytechnic institutions. It is obvious that in the long run, improvements in the science and engineering dimensions of education is a necessary government priority in almost all countries of the world. Pakistan is no exception. In the shorter run: (i) effective partnerships may be developed with twinning academic institutions abroad, (ii) input and two-way exchanges can be developed between academic institutions and the private sector, and (iii) various Diaspora programs may be targeted specifically at expatriate IT experts and technical educationists to transfer knowledge through interactions with the academia, the scientific community, Government, and even industry. 309. The transfer of knowledge to commercial application remains a major challenge for Pakistan’s industry; this may be addressed through the science and technology policy. There is a need to orient scientific research towards the needs of industry. Programs to encourage research partnerships and facilitate mobility between research and industry can help promote commercialization of academic research. Specific examples include: (i) Industry managers on governing boards of the academic institutions can strengthen linkages. (ii) Patenting activity placed on par with publishing papers for academic career advancement would facilitate this process. (iii) Examining Korea and Japan’s experience in cost sharing with industry for specific R&D research, which has led to 50-70 percent of their R&D costs being met by the industry, could help in this respect. 310. Bridging institutions like incubators, science and technology parks and technology transfer centers can be focal points for public private partnerships to directly facilitate local innovation. In addition to physical infrastructure, bridging institutions may incorporate a range of ‘soft’ services―such as advisory, mentoring, training, and business consultancy in areas of production methods, quality systems, business development, export marketing, and access to loan finance, etc. to be provided to companies in business incubators. 311. Quality certification by a recognized accreditation agency would help to promote technology-related exports. The PNAC needs to be strengthened to attain international recognition 93 The favourable tax policies include 0 percent income tax on software exports until 2016; 0 percent income tax for software firms; 0 percent sales tax on computer hardware and software; and 0 percent custom duties on IT equipment. Other incentives include 100 percent repatriation of profits for IT companies and 100 percent allowance of foreign equity in the IT sector. 126 by seeking partnerships and joint ventures with reputed accreditation agencies around the world to build capacity, raise its stature and increase credibility of the bodies accredited by PNAC. Further, there is a need to have a separate metrology institute that does calibration and the PNAC should only be an accreditation agency. 312. Rationalization of the R&D subsidy is necessary. The fund is targeted more as an export support than for any activity related to R&D. While many countries have fiscal incentives for firms to invest in R&D and adopt new technologies, literature on tax incentives in developed countries has found more mixed results in the majority of the cases analyzed. The main reason for these findings is that, in comparison with the availability and quality of appropriately skilled labor, the provision of fiscal or financial incentives is of limited relevance for R&D investments (UNCTAD). 313. Venture capital is crucial to financing start-up technology-based businesses in their initial loss-making phases. The Government may consider the creation of privately-managed venture capital fund seed and venture capital funds to bridge the gap between research and technology commercialization and encourage a ‘business angel’ network. 314. Technology adoption schemes financed through matching grants can be powerful ways of kick-starting innovation. The schemes can help finance consultancy or training services to advise domestic firms, and help large firms understand and negotiate technology licensing agreements. For smaller firms, technical assistance could be provided to help raise quality standards and organizational processes for outsourcing. 127